101 Innovation Drive
San Jose, CA 95134
www.altera.com
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
SII5V1-4.5
Copyright © 2011 Altera Corporation. All rights reserved. Altera, The Programmable Solutions Company, the stylized Altera logo, specific device des-
ignations, and all other words and logos that are identified as trademarks and/or service marks are, unless noted otherwise, the trademarks and
service marks of Altera Corporation in the U.S. and other countries. All other product or service names are the property of their respective holders. Al-
tera products are protected under numerous U.S. and foreign patents and pending applications, maskwork rights, and copyrights. Altera warrants
performance of its semiconductor products to current specifications in accordance with Altera's standard warranty, but reserves the right to make
changes to any products and services at any time without notice. Altera assumes no responsibility or liabil-
ity arising out of the application or use of any information, product, or service described herein except as
expressly agreed to in writing by Altera Corporation. Altera customers are advised to obtain the latest ver-
sion of device specifications before relying on any published information and before placing orders for
products or services.
ii Altera Corporation
Altera Corporation iii
Contents
Chapter Revision Dates .......................................................................... vii
About this Handbook ................................................................................ i
How to Contact Altera ............................................................................................................................... i
Typographic Conventions ......................................................................................................................... i
Section I. Stratix II Device Family Data Sheet
Revision History ....................................................................................................................... Section I–1
Chapter 1. Introduction
Introduction ............................................................................................................................................ 1–1
Features ................................................................................................................................................... 1–1
Document Revision History ................................................................................................................. 1–6
Chapter 2. Stratix II Architecture
Functional Description .......................................................................................................................... 2–1
Logic Array Blocks ................................................................................................................................ 2–3
LAB Interconnects ............................................................................................................................ 2–4
LAB Control Signals ......................................................................................................................... 2–5
Adaptive Logic Modules ...................................................................................................................... 2–6
ALM Operating Modes ................................................................................................................... 2–9
Register Chain ................................................................................................................................. 2–20
Clear & Preset Logic Control ........................................................................................................ 2–22
MultiTrack Interconnect ..................................................................................................................... 2–22
TriMatrix Memory ............................................................................................................................... 2–28
Memory Block Size ......................................................................................................................... 2–29
Digital Signal Processing Block ......................................................................................................... 2–40
Modes of Operation ....................................................................................................................... 2–44
DSP Block Interface ........................................................................................................................ 2–44
PLLs & Clock Networks ..................................................................................................................... 2–48
Global & Hierarchical Clocking ................................................................................................... 2–48
Enhanced & Fast PLLs ................................................................................................................... 2–57
Enhanced PLLs ............................................................................................................................... 2–68
Fast PLLs .......................................................................................................................................... 2–69
I/O Structure ........................................................................................................................................ 2–69
Double Data Rate I/O Pins ........................................................................................................... 2–77
External RAM Interfacing ............................................................................................................. 2–81
Programmable Drive Strength .....................................................................................................283
iv Altera Corporation
Contents Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Open-Drain Output ........................................................................................................................ 2–84
Bus Hold .......................................................................................................................................... 2–84
Programmable Pull-Up Resistor .................................................................................................. 2–85
Advanced I/O Standard Support ................................................................................................ 2–85
On-Chip Termination .................................................................................................................... 2–89
MultiVolt I/O Interface ................................................................................................................. 2–93
High-Speed Differential I/O with DPA Support ............................................................................ 2–96
Dedicated Circuitry with DPA Support .................................................................................... 2–100
Fast PLL & Channel Layout ........................................................................................................ 2–102
Document Revision History ............................................................................................................. 2–104
Chapter 3. Configuration & Testing
IEEE Std. 1149.1 JTAG Boundary-Scan Support ............................................................................... 3–1
SignalTap II Embedded Logic Analyzer ............................................................................................ 3–4
Configuration ......................................................................................................................................... 3–4
Operating Modes .............................................................................................................................. 3–5
Configuration Schemes ................................................................................................................... 3–7
Configuring Stratix II FPGAs with JRunner ............................................................................... 3–10
Programming Serial Configuration Devices with SRunner ..................................................... 3–10
Configuring Stratix II FPGAs with the MicroBlaster Driver ................................................... 3–11
PLL Reconfiguration ...................................................................................................................... 3–11
Temperature Sensing Diode (TSD) ................................................................................................... 3–11
Automated Single Event Upset (SEU) Detection ............................................................................ 3–13
Custom-Built Circuitry .................................................................................................................. 3–14
Software Interface ........................................................................................................................... 3–14
Document Revision History ............................................................................................................... 3–14
Chapter 4. Hot Socketing & Power-On Reset
Stratix II
Hot-Socketing Specifications ............................................................................................................... 4–1
Devices Can Be Driven Before Power-Up .................................................................................... 4–2
I/O Pins Remain Tri-Stated During Power-Up ........................................................................... 4–2
Signal Pins Do Not Drive the VCCIO, VCCINT or VCCPD Power Supplies .................................... 4–2
Hot Socketing Feature Implementation in Stratix II Devices .......................................................... 4–3
Power-On Reset Circuitry .................................................................................................................... 4–5
Document Revision History ................................................................................................................. 4–6
Chapter 5. DC & Switching Characteristics
Operating Conditions ........................................................................................................................... 5–1
Absolute Maximum Ratings ........................................................................................................... 5–1
Recommended Operating Conditions .......................................................................................... 5–2
DC Electrical Characteristics .......................................................................................................... 5–3
I/O Standard Specifications ........................................................................................................... 5–4
Bus Hold Specifications ................................................................................................................. 5–17
On-Chip Termination Specifications ........................................................................................... 5–17
Pin Capacitance .............................................................................................................................. 5–19
Power Consumption ........................................................................................................................... 5–20
Altera Corporation v
Contents Contents
Timing Model ....................................................................................................................................... 5–20
Preliminary & Final Timing .......................................................................................................... 5–20
I/O Timing Measurement Methodology .................................................................................... 5–21
Performance .................................................................................................................................... 5–27
Internal Timing Parameters .......................................................................................................... 5–34
Stratix II Clock Timing Parameters .............................................................................................. 5–41
Clock Network Skew Adders .......................................................................................................550
IOE Programmable Delay ............................................................................................................. 5–51
Default Capacitive Loading of Different I/O Standards .......................................................... 5–52
I/O Delays ....................................................................................................................................... 5–54
Maximum Input & Output Clock Toggle Rate .......................................................................... 5–66
Duty Cycle Distortion ......................................................................................................................... 5–77
DCD Measurement Techniques ................................................................................................... 5–78
High-Speed I/O Specifications .......................................................................................................... 5–87
PLL Timing Specifications .................................................................................................................. 5–91
External Memory Interface Specifications ....................................................................................... 5–94
JTAG Timing Specifications ............................................................................................................... 5–96
Document Revision History ............................................................................................................... 5–97
Chapter 6. Reference & Ordering Information
Software .................................................................................................................................................. 6–1
Device Pin-Outs ..................................................................................................................................... 6–1
Ordering Information ........................................................................................................................... 6–1
Document Revision History ................................................................................................................. 6–2
vi Altera Corporation
Contents Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Altera Corporation vii
Chapter Revision Dates
The chapters in this book, Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1, were revised on the following dates.
Where chapters or groups of chapters are available separately, part numbers are listed.
Chapter 1. Introduction
Revised: May 2007
Part number: SII51001-4.2
Chapter 2. Stratix II Architecture
Revised: May 2007
Part number: SII51002-4.3
Chapter 3. Configuration & Testing
Revised: May 2007
Part number: SII51003-4.2
Chapter 4. Hot Socketing & Power-On Reset
Revised: May 2007
Part number: SII51004-3.2
Chapter 5. DC & Switching Characteristics
Revised: April 2011
Part number: SII51005-4.5
Chapter 6. Reference & Ordering Information
Revised: April 2011
Part number: SII51006-2.2
viii Altera Corporation
Chapter Revision Dates Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Altera Corporation i
Preliminary
About this Handbook
This handbook provides comprehensive information about the Altera®
Stratix®II family of devices.
How to Contact
Altera
For the most up-to-date information about Altera products, refer to the
following table.
Typographic
Conventions
This document uses the typographic conventions shown below.
Contact (1) Contact
Method Address
Technical support Website www.altera.com/support
Technical training Website www.altera.com/training
Email custrain@altera.com
Product literature Email www.altera.com/literature
Altera literature services Website literature@altera.com
Non-technical support (General)
(Software Licensing)
Email nacomp@altera.com
Email authorization@altera.com
Note to table:
(1) You can also contact your local Altera sales office or sales representative.
Visual Cue Meaning
Bold Type with Initial
Capital Letters
Command names, dialog box titles, checkbox options, and dialog box options are
shown in bold, initial capital letters. Example: Save As dialog box.
bold type External timing parameters, directory names, project names, disk drive names,
filenames, filename extensions, and software utility names are shown in bold
type. Examples: fMAX, \qdesigns directory, d: drive, chiptrip.gdf file.
Italic Type with Initial Capital
Letters
Document titles are shown in italic type with initial capital letters. Example: AN 75:
High-Speed Board Design.
ii Altera Corporation
Preliminary
Typographic Conventions Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Italic type Internal timing parameters and variables are shown in italic type.
Examples: tPIA, n + 1.
Variable names are enclosed in angle brackets (< >) and shown in italic type.
Example: <file name>, <project name>.pof file.
Initial Capital Letters Keyboard keys and menu names are shown with initial capital letters. Examples:
Delete key, the Options menu.
“Subheading Title” References to sections within a document and titles of on-line help topics are
shown in quotation marks. Example: “Typographic Conventions.
Courier type Signal and port names are shown in lowercase Courier type. Examples: data1,
tdi, input. Active-low signals are denoted by suffix n, e.g., resetn.
Anything that must be typed exactly as it appears is shown in Courier type. For
example: c:\qdesigns\tutorial\chiptrip.gdf. Also, sections of an
actual file, such as a Report File, references to parts of files (e.g., the AHDL
keyword SUBDESIGN), as well as logic function names (e.g., TRI) are shown in
Courier.
1., 2., 3., and
a., b., c., etc.
Numbered steps are used in a list of items when the sequence of the items is
important, such as the steps listed in a procedure.
Bullets are used in a list of items when the sequence of the items is not important.
v The checkmark indicates a procedure that consists of one step only.
1 The hand points to information that requires special attention.
cThe caution indicates required information that needs special consideration and
understanding and should be read prior to starting or continuing with the
procedure or process.
wThe warning indicates information that should be read prior to starting or
continuing the procedure or processes
r The angled arrow indicates you should press the Enter key.
f The feet direct you to more information on a particular topic.
Visual Cue Meaning
Altera Corporation Section I–1
Section I. Stratix II Device
Family Data Sheet
This section provides the data sheet specifications for Stratix®II devices.
This section contains feature definitions of the internal architecture,
configuration and JTAG boundary-scan testing information, DC
operating conditions, AC timing parameters, a reference to power
consumption, and ordering information for Stratix II devices.
This section contains the following chapters:
Chapter 1, Introduction
Chapter 2, Stratix II Architecture
Chapter 3, Configuration & Testing
Chapter 4, Hot Socketing & Power-On Reset
Chapter 5, DC & Switching Characteristics
Chapter 6, Reference & Ordering Information
Revision History Refer to each chapter for its own specific revision history. For information
on when each chapter was updated, refer to the Chapter Revision Dates
section, which appears in the full handbook.
Section I–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Family Data Sheet Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Altera Corporation 1–1
May 2007
1. Introduction
Introduction The Stratix®II FPGA family is based on a 1.2-V, 90-nm, all-layer copper
SRAM process and features a new logic structure that maximizes
performance, and enables device densities approaching 180,000
equivalent logic elements (LEs). Stratix II devices offer up to 9 Mbits of
on-chip, TriMatrix™ memory for demanding, memory intensive
applications and has up to 96 DSP blocks with up to 384 (18-bit × 18-bit)
multipliers for efficient implementation of high performance filters and
other DSP functions. Various high-speed external memory interfaces are
supported, including double data rate (DDR) SDRAM and DDR2
SDRAM, RLDRAM II, quad data rate (QDR) II SRAM, and single data
rate (SDR) SDRAM. Stratix II devices support various I/O standards
along with support for 1-gigabit per second (Gbps) source synchronous
signaling with DPA circuitry. Stratix II devices offer a complete clock
management solution with internal clock frequency of up to 550 MHz
and up to 12 phase-locked loops (PLLs). Stratix II devices are also the
industry’s first FPGAs with the ability to decrypt a configuration
bitstream using the Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) algorithm to
protect designs.
Features The Stratix II family offers the following features:
15,600 to 179,400 equivalent LEs; see Table 1–1
New and innovative adaptive logic module (ALM), the basic
building block of the Stratix II architecture, maximizes performance
and resource usage efficiency
Up to 9,383,040 RAM bits (1,172,880 bytes) available without
reducing logic resources
TriMatrix memory consisting of three RAM block sizes to implement
true dual-port memory and first-in first-out (FIFO) buffers
High-speed DSP blocks provide dedicated implementation of
multipliers (at up to 450 MHz), multiply-accumulate functions, and
finite impulse response (FIR) filters
Up to 16 global clocks with 24 clocking resources per device region
Clock control blocks support dynamic clock network enable/disable,
which allows clock networks to power down to reduce power
consumption in user mode
Up to 12 PLLs (four enhanced PLLs and eight fast PLLs) per device
provide spread spectrum, programmable bandwidth, clock switch-
over, real-time PLL reconfiguration, and advanced multiplication
and phase shifting
SII51001-4.2
1–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Features
Support for numerous single-ended and differential I/O standards
High-speed differential I/O support with DPA circuitry for 1-Gbps
performance
Support for high-speed networking and communications bus
standards including Parallel RapidIO, SPI-4 Phase 2 (POS-PHY
Level 4), HyperTransport™ technology, and SFI-4
Support for high-speed external memory, including DDR and DDR2
SDRAM, RLDRAM II, QDR II SRAM, and SDR SDRAM
Support for multiple intellectual property megafunctions from
Altera MegaCore® functions and Altera Megafunction Partners
Program (AMPPSM) megafunctions
Support for design security using configuration bitstream
encryption
Support for remote configuration updates
Table 1–1. Stratix II FPGA Family Features
Feature EP2S15 EP2S30 EP2S60 EP2S90 EP2S130 EP2S180
ALMs 6,240 13,552 24,176 36,384 53,016 71,760
Adaptive look-up tables (ALUTs) (1) 12,480 27,104 48,352 72,768 106,032 143,520
Equivalent LEs (2) 15,600 33,880 60,440 90,960 132,540 179,400
M512 RAM blocks 104 202 329 488 699 930
M4K RAM blocks 78 144 255 408 609 768
M-RAM blocks 012469
Total RAM bits 419,328 1,369,728 2,544,192 4,520,488 6,747,840 9,383,040
DSP blocks 12 16 36 48 63 96
18-bit × 18-bit multipliers (3) 48 64 144 192 252 384
Enhanced PLLs 2 2 4 4 4 4
Fast PLLs 448888
Maximum user I/O pins 366 500 718 902 1,126 1,170
Notes to Tab l e 1 1 :
(1) One ALM contains two ALUTs. The ALUT is the cell used in the Quartus®II software for logic synthesis.
(2) This is the equivalent number of LEs in a Stratix device (four-input LUT-based architecture).
(3) These multipliers are implemented using the DSP blocks.
Altera Corporation 1–3
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Introduction
Stratix II devices are available in space-saving FineLine BGA® packages
(see Tables 1–2 and 1–3).
All Stratix II devices support vertical migration within the same package
(for example, you can migrate between the EP2S15, EP2S30, and EP2S60
devices in the 672-pin FineLine BGA package). Vertical migration means
that you can migrate to devices whose dedicated pins, configuration pins,
and power pins are the same for a given package across device densities.
To ensure that a board layout supports migratable densities within one
package offering, enable the applicable vertical migration path within the
Quartus II software (Assignments menu > Device > Migration Devices).
Table 1–2. Stratix II Package Options & I/O Pin Counts Notes (1), (2)
Device 484-Pin
FineLine BGA
484-Pin
Hybrid
FineLine
BGA
672-Pin
FineLine
BGA
780-Pin
FineLine
BGA
1,020-Pin
FineLine BGA
1,508-Pin
FineLine BGA
EP2S15 342 366
EP2S30 342 500
EP2S60 (3) 334 492 718
EP2S90 (3) 308 534 758 902
EP2S130 (3) 534 742 1,126
EP2S180 (3) 742 1,170
Notes to Tab l e 1 2 :
(1) All I/O pin counts include eight dedicated clock input pins (clk1p, clk1n, clk3p, clk3n, clk9p, clk9n,
clk11p, and clk11n) that can be used for data inputs.
(2) The Quartus II software I/O pin counts include one additional pin, PLL_ENA, which is not available as general-
purpose I/O pins. The PLL_ENA pin can only be used to enable the PLLs within the device.
(3) The I/O pin counts for the EP2S60, EP2S90, EP2S130, and EP2S180 devices in the 1020-pin and 1508-pin packages
include eight dedicated fast PLL clock inputs (FPLL7CLKp/n, FPLL8CLKp/n, FPLL9CLKp/n, and
FPLL10CLKp/n) that can be used for data inputs.
Table 1–3. Stratix II FineLine BGA Package Sizes
Dimension 484 Pin 484-Pin
Hybrid 672 Pin 780 Pin 1,020 Pin 1,508 Pin
Pitch (mm) 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00 1.00
Area (mm2) 529 729 729 841 1,089 1,600
Length × width
(mm × mm)
23 × 23 27 × 27 27 × 27 29 × 29 33 × 33 40 × 40
1–4 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Features
After compilation, check the information messages for a full list of I/O,
DQ, LVDS, and other pins that are not available because of the selected
migration path.
Table 1–4 lists the Stratix II device package offerings and shows the total
number of non-migratable user I/O pins when migrating from one
density device to a larger density device. Additional I/O pins may not be
migratable if migrating from the larger device to the smaller density
device.
1When moving from one density to a larger density, the larger
density device may have fewer user I/O pins. The larger device
requires more power and ground pins to support the additional
logic within the device. Use the Quartus II Pin Planner to
determine which user I/O pins are migratable between the two
devices.
1To determine if your user I/O assignments are correct, run the
I/O Assignment Analysis command in the Quartus II software
(Processing > Start > Start I/O Assignment Analysis).
fRefer to the I/O Management chapter in volume 2 of the Quartus II
Handbook for more information on pin migration.
Table 1–4. Total Number of Non-Migratable I/O Pins for Stratix II Vertical Migration Paths
Vertical Migration
Path
484-Pin
FineLine BGA
672-Pin
FineLine BGA
780-Pin
FineLine BGA
1020-Pin
FineLine BGA
1508-Pin
FineLine BGA
EP2S15 to EP2S30 0 (1) 0
EP2S15 to EP2S60 8 (1) 0
EP2S30 to EP2S60 8 (1) 8
EP2S60 to EP2S90 0
EP2S60 to EP2S130 0
EP2S60 to EP2S180 0
EP2S90 to EP2S130 0 (1) 16 17
EP2S90 to EP2S180 16 0
EP2S130 to EP2S180 0 0
Note to Table 14 :
(1) Some of the DQ/DQS pins are not migratable. Refer to the Quartus II software information messages for more
detailed information.
Altera Corporation 1–5
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Introduction
Stratix II devices are available in up to three speed grades, -3, -4, and -5,
with -3 being the fastest. Table 1–5 shows Stratix II device speed-grade
offerings.
Table 1–5. Stratix II Device Speed Grades
Device Temperature
Grade
484-Pin
FineLine
BGA
484-Pin
Hybrid
FineLine
BGA
672-Pin
FineLine
BGA
780-Pin
FineLine
BGA
1,020-Pin
FineLine
BGA
1,508-Pin
FineLine
BGA
EP2S15 Commercial -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5
Industrial -4 -4
EP2S30 Commercial -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5
Industrial -4 -4
EP2S60 Commercial -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5
Industrial -4 -4 -4
EP2S90 Commercial -4, -5 -4, -5 -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5
Industrial -4 -4
EP2S130 Commercial -4, -5 -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5
Industrial -4 -4
EP2S180 Commercial -3, -4, -5 -3, -4, -5
Industrial -4 -4
1–6 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Document Revision History
Document
Revision History
Table 1–6 shows the revision history for this chapter.
Table 1–6. Document Revision History
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
May 2007, v4.2 Moved Document Revision History to the end of the
chapter.
April 2006, v4.1 Updated “Features” section.
Removed Note 4 from Table 1–2.
Updated Table 1–4.
December 2005,
v4.0
Updated Tables 1–2, 1–4, and 1–5.
Updated Figure 2–43.
July 2005, v3.1 Added vertical migration information, including
Table 1–4.
Updated Table 1–5.
May 2005, v3.0 Updated “Features” section.
Updated Table 1–2.
March 2005,
v2.1
Updated “Introduction” and “Features” sections.
January 2005,
v2.0
Added note to Table 1–2.
October 2004,
v1.2
Updated Tables 1–2, 1–3, and 1–5.
July 2004, v1.1 Updated Tables 1–1 and 1–2.
Updated “Features” section.
February 2004,
v1.0
Added document to the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Altera Corporation 2–1
May 2007
2. Stratix II Architecture
Functional
Description
Stratix®II devices contain a two-dimensional row- and column-based
architecture to implement custom logic. A series of column and row
interconnects of varying length and speed provides signal interconnects
between logic array blocks (LABs), memory block structures (M512 RAM,
M4K RAM, and M-RAM blocks), and digital signal processing (DSP)
blocks.
Each LAB consists of eight adaptive logic modules (ALMs). An ALM is
the Stratix II device family’s basic building block of logic providing
efficient implementation of user logic functions. LABs are grouped into
rows and columns across the device.
M512 RAM blocks are simple dual-port memory blocks with 512 bits plus
parity (576 bits). These blocks provide dedicated simple dual-port or
single-port memory up to 18-bits wide at up to 500 MHz. M512 blocks are
grouped into columns across the device in between certain LABs.
M4K RAM blocks are true dual-port memory blocks with 4K bits plus
parity (4,608 bits). These blocks provide dedicated true dual-port, simple
dual-port, or single-port memory up to 36-bits wide at up to 550 MHz.
These blocks are grouped into columns across the device in between
certain LABs.
M-RAM blocks are true dual-port memory blocks with 512K bits plus
parity (589,824 bits). These blocks provide dedicated true dual-port,
simple dual-port, or single-port memory up to 144-bits wide at up to
420 MHz. Several M-RAM blocks are located individually in the device's
logic array.
DSP blocks can implement up to either eight full-precision 9 × 9-bit
multipliers, four full-precision 18 × 18-bit multipliers, or one
full-precision 36 × 36-bit multiplier with add or subtract features. The
DSP blocks support Q1.15 format rounding and saturation in the
multiplier and accumulator stages. These blocks also contain shift
registers for digital signal processing applications, including finite
impulse response (FIR) and infinite impulse response (IIR) filters. DSP
blocks are grouped into columns across the device and operate at up to
450 MHz.
SII51002-4.3
2–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Functional Description
Each Stratix II device I/O pin is fed by an I/O element (IOE) located at
the end of LAB rows and columns around the periphery of the device.
I/O pins support numerous single-ended and differential I/O standards.
Each IOE contains a bidirectional I/O buffer and six registers for
registering input, output, and output-enable signals. When used with
dedicated clocks, these registers provide exceptional performance and
interface support with external memory devices such as DDR and DDR2
SDRAM, RLDRAM II, and QDR II SRAM devices. High-speed serial
interface channels with dynamic phase alignment (DPA) support data
transfer at up to 1 Gbps using LVDS or HyperTransportTM technology I/O
standards.
Figure 2–1 shows an overview of the Stratix II device.
Figure 2–1. Stratix II Block Diagram
M512 RAM Blocks for
Dual-Port Memory, Shift
Registers, & FIFO Buffers
DSP Blocks for
Multiplication and Full
Implementation of FIR Filters
M4K RAM Blocks
for True Dual-Port
Memory & Other Embedded
Memory Functions
IOEs Support DDR, PCI, PCI-X,
SSTL-3, SSTL-2, HSTL-1, HSTL-2,
LVDS, HyperTransport & other
I/O Standards
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
IOEs
LABs
LABs
IOEs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
IOEs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs LABs
LABs
IOEs IOEs
LABs
LABs LABs
LABs LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABsLABs
LABsLABs
LABsLABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
LABs
DSP
Block
M-RAM Block
Altera Corporation 2–3
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The number of M512 RAM, M4K RAM, and DSP blocks varies by device
along with row and column numbers and M-RAM blocks. Table 2–1 lists
the resources available in Stratix II devices.
Logic Array
Blocks
Each LAB consists of eight ALMs, carry chains, shared arithmetic chains,
LAB control signals, local interconnect, and register chain connection
lines. The local interconnect transfers signals between ALMs in the same
LAB. Register chain connections transfer the output of an ALM register to
the adjacent ALM register in an LAB. The Quartus®II Compiler places
associated logic in an LAB or adjacent LABs, allowing the use of local,
shared arithmetic chain, and register chain connections for performance
and area efficiency. Figure 2–2 shows the Stratix II LAB structure.
Table 2–1. Stratix II Device Resources
Device M512 RAM
Columns/Blocks
M4K RAM
Columns/Blocks
M-RAM
Blocks
DSP Block
Columns/Blocks
LAB
Columns LAB Rows
EP2S15 4 / 104 3 / 78 0 2 / 12 30 26
EP2S30 6 / 202 4 / 144 1 2 / 16 49 36
EP2S60 7 / 329 5 / 255 2 3 / 36 62 51
EP2S90 8 / 488 6 / 408 4 3 / 48 71 68
EP2S130 9 / 699 7 / 609 6 3 / 63 81 87
EP2S180 11 / 930 8 / 768 9 4 / 96 100 96
2–4 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Logic Array Blocks
Figure 2–2. Stratix II LAB Structure
LAB Interconnects
The LAB local interconnect can drive ALMs in the same LAB. It is driven
by column and row interconnects and ALM outputs in the same LAB.
Neighboring LABs, M512 RAM blocks, M4K RAM blocks, M-RAM
blocks, or DSP blocks from the left and right can also drive an LAB's local
interconnect through the direct link connection. The direct link
connection feature minimizes the use of row and column interconnects,
providing higher performance and flexibility. Each ALM can drive
24 ALMs through fast local and direct link interconnects. Figure 2–3
shows the direct link connection.
Direct link
interconnect from
adjacent block
Direct link
interconnect to
adjacent block
Row Interconnects of
Variable Speed & Length
Column Interconnects of
Variable Speed & Length
Local Interconnect is Driven
from Either Side by Columns & LABs,
& from Above by Rows
Local Interconnect LAB
Direct link
interconnect from
adjacent block
Direct link
interconnect to
adjacent block
ALMs
Altera Corporation 2–5
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–3. Direct Link Connection
LAB Control Signals
Each LAB contains dedicated logic for driving control signals to its ALMs.
The control signals include three clocks, three clock enables, two
asynchronous clears, synchronous clear, asynchronous preset/load, and
synchronous load control signals. This gives a maximum of 11 control
signals at a time. Although synchronous load and clear signals are
generally used when implementing counters, they can also be used with
other functions.
Each LAB can use three clocks and three clock enable signals. However,
there can only be up to two unique clocks per LAB, as shown in the LAB
control signal generation circuit in Figure 2–4. Each LAB's clock and clock
enable signals are linked. For example, any ALM in a particular LAB
using the labclk1 signal also uses labclkena1. If the LAB uses both
the rising and falling edges of a clock, it also uses two LAB-wide clock
signals. De-asserting the clock enable signal turns off the corresponding
LAB-wide clock.
Each LAB can use two asynchronous clear signals and an asynchronous
load/preset signal. By default, the Quartus II software uses a NOT gate
push-back technique to achieve preset. If you disable the NOT gate
push-up option or assign a given register to power up high using the
Quartus II software, the preset is achieved using the asynchronous load
ALMs
Direct link
interconnect
to right
Direct link interconnect from
right LAB, TriMatrix memory
block, DSP block, or IOE output
Direct link interconnect from
left LAB, TriMatrix memory
block, DSP block, or IOE output
Local
Interconnect
Direct link
interconnect
to left
2–6 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
signal with asynchronous load data input tied high. When the
asynchronous load/preset signal is used, the labclkena0 signal is no
longer available.
The LAB row clocks [5..0] and LAB local interconnect generate the
LAB-wide control signals. The MultiTrackTM interconnect's inherent low
skew allows clock and control signal distribution in addition to data.
Figure 2–4 shows the LAB control signal generation circuit.
Figure 2–4. LAB-Wide Control Signals
Adaptive Logic
Modules
The basic building block of logic in the Stratix II architecture, the adaptive
logic module (ALM), provides advanced features with efficient logic
utilization. Each ALM contains a variety of look-up table (LUT)-based
resources that can be divided between two adaptive LUTs (ALUTs). With
up to eight inputs to the two ALUTs, one ALM can implement various
combinations of two functions. This adaptability allows the ALM to be
Dedicated Row LAB Clocks
Local Interconnect
Local Interconnect
Local Interconnect
Local Interconnect
Local Interconnect
Local Interconnect
labclk2 syncload
labclkena0
or asyncload
or labpreset
labclk0
labclk1 labclr1
labclkena1 labclkena2 labclr0 synclr
6
6
6
There are two unique
clock signals per LAB.
Altera Corporation 2–7
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
completely backward-compatible with four-input LUT architectures. One
ALM can also implement any function of up to six inputs and certain
seven-input functions.
In addition to the adaptive LUT-based resources, each ALM contains two
programmable registers, two dedicated full adders, a carry chain, a
shared arithmetic chain, and a register chain. Through these dedicated
resources, the ALM can efficiently implement various arithmetic
functions and shift registers. Each ALM drives all types of interconnects:
local, row, column, carry chain, shared arithmetic chain, register chain,
and direct link interconnects. Figure 2–5 shows a high-level block
diagram of the Stratix II ALM while Figure 2–6 shows a detailed view of
all the connections in the ALM.
Figure 2–5. High-Level Block Diagram of the Stratix II ALM
DQ
To general or
local routing
reg0
To general or
local routing
datae0
dataf0
shared_arith_in
shared_arith_out
reg_chain_in
reg_chain_out
adder0
dataa
datab
datac
datad
Combinational
Logic
datae1
dataf1
DQ
To general or
local routing
reg1
To general or
local routing
adder1
carry_in
carry_out
2–8 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
Figure 2–6. Stratix II ALM Details
PRN/ALD
CLRN
D
A D ATA
ENA
Q
PRN/ALD
CLRN
D
A D ATA
ENA
Q
4-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
dataa
datac
datae0
dataf0
dataf1
datae1
datab
datad
V
CC
reg_chain_in sclr asyncload
syncload ena[2..0]
shared_arith_in
carry_in
carry_out clk[2..0]
Local
Interconnect
Row, column &
direct link routing
Row, column &
direct link routing
Local
Interconnect
Row, column &
direct link routing
Row, column &
direct link routing
reg_chain_out
shared_arith_out aclr[1..0]
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Altera Corporation 2–9
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
One ALM contains two programmable registers. Each register has data,
clock, clock enable, synchronous and asynchronous clear, asynchronous
load data, and synchronous and asynchronous load/preset inputs.
Global signals, general-purpose I/O pins, or any internal logic can drive
the register's clock and clear control signals. Either general-purpose I/O
pins or internal logic can drive the clock enable, preset, asynchronous
load, and asynchronous load data. The asynchronous load data input
comes from the datae or dataf input of the ALM, which are the same
inputs that can be used for register packing. For combinational functions,
the register is bypassed and the output of the LUT drives directly to the
outputs of the ALM.
Each ALM has two sets of outputs that drive the local, row, and column
routing resources. The LUT, adder, or register output can drive these
output drivers independently (see Figure 2–6). For each set of output
drivers, two ALM outputs can drive column, row, or direct link routing
connections, and one of these ALM outputs can also drive local
interconnect resources. This allows the LUT or adder to drive one output
while the register drives another output. This feature, called register
packing, improves device utilization because the device can use the
register and the combinational logic for unrelated functions. Another
special packing mode allows the register output to feed back into the LUT
of the same ALM so that the register is packed with its own fan-out LUT.
This provides another mechanism for improved fitting. The ALM can also
drive out registered and unregistered versions of the LUT or adder
output.
fSee the Performance & Logic Efficiency Analysis of Stratix II Devices White
Paper for more information on the efficiencies of the Stratix II ALM and
comparisons with previous architectures.
ALM Operating Modes
The Stratix II ALM can operate in one of the following modes:
Normal mode
Extended LUT mode
Arithmetic mode
Shared arithmetic mode
Each mode uses ALM resources differently. In each mode, eleven
available inputs to the ALM--the eight data inputs from the LAB local
interconnect; carry-in from the previous ALM or LAB; the shared
arithmetic chain connection from the previous ALM or LAB; and the
register chain connection--are directed to different destinations to
implement the desired logic function. LAB-wide signals provide clock,
asynchronous clear, asynchronous preset/load, synchronous clear,
2–10 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
synchronous load, and clock enable control for the register. These LAB-
wide signals are available in all ALM modes. See the “LAB Control
Signals” section for more information on the LAB-wide control signals.
The Quartus II software and supported third-party synthesis tools, in
conjunction with parameterized functions such as library of
parameterized modules (LPM) functions, automatically choose the
appropriate mode for common functions such as counters, adders,
subtractors, and arithmetic functions. If required, you can also create
special-purpose functions that specify which ALM operating mode to use
for optimal performance.
Normal Mode
The normal mode is suitable for general logic applications and
combinational functions. In this mode, up to eight data inputs from the
LAB local interconnect are inputs to the combinational logic. The normal
mode allows two functions to be implemented in one Stratix II ALM, or
an ALM to implement a single function of up to six inputs. The ALM can
support certain combinations of completely independent functions and
various combinations of functions which have common inputs.
Figure 2–7 shows the supported LUT combinations in normal mode.
Altera Corporation 2–11
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–7. ALM in Normal Mode Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–7:
(1) Combinations of functions with fewer inputs than those shown are also supported. For example, combinations of
functions with the following number of inputs are supported: 4 and 3, 3 and 3, 3 and 2, 5 and 2, etc.
The normal mode provides complete backward compatibility with four-
input LUT architectures. Two independent functions of four inputs or less
can be implemented in one Stratix II ALM. In addition, a five-input
function and an independent three-input function can be implemented
without sharing inputs.
6-Input
LUT
dataf0
datae0
dataf0
datae0
dataa
datab
dataa
datab
datab
datac
datac
dataf0
datae0
dataa
datac
6-Input
LUT
datad
datad
datae1
combout0
combout1
combout0
combout1
combout0
combout1
dataf1
datae1
dataf1
datad
datae1
dataf1
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
6-Input
LUT
dataf0
datae0
dataa
datab
datac
datad
combout0
5-Input
LUT
5-Input
LUT
dataf0
datae0
dataa
datab
datac
datad
combout0
combout1
datae1
dataf1
5-Input
LUT
dataf0
datae0
dataa
datab
datac
datad
combout0
combout1
datae1
dataf1
5-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
2–12 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
For the packing of two five-input functions into one ALM, the functions
must have at least two common inputs. The common inputs are dataa
and datab. The combination of a four-input function with a five-input
function requires one common input (either dataa or datab).
In the case of implementing two six-input functions in one ALM, four
inputs must be shared and the combinational function must be the same.
For example, a 4 × 2 crossbar switch (two 4-to-1 multiplexers with
common inputs and unique select lines) can be implemented in one ALM,
as shown in Figure 2–8. The shared inputs are dataa, datab, datac, and
datad, while the unique select lines are datae0 and dataf0 for
function0, and datae1 and dataf1 for function1. This crossbar
switch consumes four LUTs in a four-input LUT-based architecture.
Figure 2–8. 4 × 2 Crossbar Switch Example
In a sparsely used device, functions that could be placed into one ALM
may be implemented in separate ALMs. The Quartus II Compiler spreads
a design out to achieve the best possible performance. As a device begins
to fill up, the Quartus II software automatically utilizes the full potential
of the Stratix II ALM. The Quartus II Compiler automatically searches for
functions of common inputs or completely independent functions to be
placed into one ALM and to make efficient use of the device resources. In
addition, you can manually control resource usage by setting location
assignments.
Any six-input function can be implemented utilizing inputs dataa,
datab, datac, datad, and either datae0 and dataf0 or datae1 and
dataf1. If datae0 and dataf0 are utilized, the output is driven to
register0, and/or register0 is bypassed and the data drives out to
the interconnect using the top set of output drivers (see Figure 2–9). If
Altera Corporation 2–13
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
datae1 and dataf1 are utilized, the output drives to register1
and/or bypasses register1 and drives to the interconnect using the
bottom set of output drivers. The Quartus II Compiler automatically
selects the inputs to the LUT. Asynchronous load data for the register
comes from the datae or dataf input of the ALM. ALMs in normal
mode support register packing.
Figure 2–9. 6-Input Function in Normal Mode Notes (1), (2)
Notes to Figure 2–9:
(1) If datae1 and dataf1 are used as inputs to the six-input function, then datae0
and dataf0 are available for register packing.
(2) The dataf1 input is available for register packing only if the six-input function is
un-registered.
Extended LUT Mode
The extended LUT mode is used to implement a specific set of
seven-input functions. The set must be a 2-to-1 multiplexer fed by two
arbitrary five-input functions sharing four inputs. Figure 2–10 shows the
template of supported seven-input functions utilizing extended LUT
mode. In this mode, if the seven-input function is unregistered, the
unused eighth input is available for register packing.
Functions that fit into the template shown in Figure 2–10 occur naturally
in designs. These functions often appear in designs as “if-else” statements
in Verilog HDL or VHDL code.
6-Input
LUT
dataf0
datae0
dataa
datab
datac
datad
datae1
dataf1
DQ
DQ
To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
reg0
reg1
These inputs are available for register packing.
(2)
2–14 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
Figure 2–10. Template for Supported Seven-Input Functions in Extended LUT Mode
Note to Figure 2–10:
(1) If the seven-input function is unregistered, the unused eighth input is available for register packing. The second
register, reg1, is not available.
Arithmetic Mode
The arithmetic mode is ideal for implementing adders, counters,
accumulators, wide parity functions, and comparators. An ALM in
arithmetic mode uses two sets of two four-input LUTs along with two
dedicated full adders. The dedicated adders allow the LUTs to be
available to perform pre-adder logic; therefore, each adder can add the
output of two four-input functions. The four LUTs share the dataa and
datab inputs. As shown in Figure 2–11, the carry-in signal feeds to
adder0, and the carry-out from adder0 feeds to carry-in of adder1. The
carry-out from adder1 drives to adder0 of the next ALM in the LAB.
ALMs in arithmetic mode can drive out registered and/or unregistered
versions of the adder outputs.
datae0
combout0
5-Input
LUT
5-Input
LUT
datac
dataa
datab
datad
dataf0
datae1
dataf1
DQ To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
reg0
This input is available
for register packing.
(1)
Altera Corporation 2–15
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–11. ALM in Arithmetic Mode
While operating in arithmetic mode, the ALM can support simultaneous
use of the adder's carry output along with combinational logic outputs. In
this operation, the adder output is ignored. This usage of the adder with
the combinational logic output provides resource savings of up to 50% for
functions that can use this ability. An example of such functionality is a
conditional operation, such as the one shown in Figure 2–12. The
equation for this example is:
R = (X < Y) ? Y : X
To implement this function, the adder is used to subtract ‘Y’ from ‘X.’ If
‘X’ is less than ‘Y,’ the carry_out signal is ‘1.’ The carry_out signal is
fed to an adder where it drives out to the LAB local interconnect. It then
feeds to the LAB-wide syncload signal. When asserted, syncload
selects the syncdata input. In this case, the data ‘Y’ drives the
syncdata inputs to the registers. If ‘X’ is greater than or equal to ‘Y,’ the
syncload signal is de-asserted and ‘X’ drives the data port of the
registers.
dataf0
datae0
carry_in
carry_out
dataa
datab
datac
datad
datae1
dataf1
DQ
DQ
To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
reg0
reg1
To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
adder1
adder0
2–16 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
Figure 2–12. Conditional Operation Example
The arithmetic mode also offers clock enable, counter enable,
synchronous up/down control, add/subtract control, synchronous clear,
synchronous load. The LAB local interconnect data inputs generate the
clock enable, counter enable, synchronous up/down and add/subtract
control signals. These control signals are good candidates for the inputs
that are shared between the four LUTs in the ALM. The synchronous clear
and synchronous load options are LAB-wide signals that affect all
registers in the LAB. The Quartus II software automatically places any
registers that are not used by the counter into other LABs.
Carry Chain
The carry chain provides a fast carry function between the dedicated
adders in arithmetic or shared arithmetic mode. Carry chains can begin in
either the first ALM or the fifth ALM in an LAB. The final carry-out signal
is routed to an ALM, where it is fed to local, row, or column interconnects.
Y[1]
Y[0]
X[0] X[0]
carry_out
X[2] X[2]
X[1] X[1]
Y[2]
DQ To general or
local routing
reg0
Comb &
Adder
Logic
Comb &
Adder
Logic
Comb &
Adder
Logic
Comb &
Adder
Logic
DQ To general or
local routing
reg1
DQ To general or
local routing
To local routing &
then to LAB-wide
syncload
reg0
syncload
syncload
syncload
ALM 1
ALM 2
R[0]
R[1]
R[2]
Carry Chain
Adder output
is not used.
syncdata
Altera Corporation 2–17
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The Quartus II Compiler automatically creates carry chain logic during
design processing, or you can create it manually during design entry.
Parameterized functions such as LPM functions automatically take
advantage of carry chains for the appropriate functions.
The Quartus II Compiler creates carry chains longer than 16 (8 ALMs in
arithmetic or shared arithmetic mode) by linking LABs together
automatically. For enhanced fitting, a long carry chain runs vertically
allowing fast horizontal connections to TriMatrix memory and DSP
blocks. A carry chain can continue as far as a full column.
To avoid routing congestion in one small area of the device when a high
fan-in arithmetic function is implemented, the LAB can support carry
chains that only utilize either the top half or the bottom half of the LAB
before connecting to the next LAB. This leaves the other half of the ALMs
in the LAB available for implementing narrower fan-in functions in
normal mode. Carry chains that use the top four ALMs in the first LAB
carry into the top half of the ALMs in the next LAB within the column.
Carry chains that use the bottom four ALMs in the first LAB carry into the
bottom half of the ALMs in the next LAB within the column. Every other
column of LABs is top-half bypassable, while the other LAB columns are
bottom-half bypassable.
See the “MultiTrack Interconnect” on page 2–22 section for more
information on carry chain interconnect.
Shared Arithmetic Mode
In shared arithmetic mode, the ALM can implement a three-input add. In
this mode, the ALM is configured with four 4-input LUTs. Each LUT
either computes the sum of three inputs or the carry of three inputs. The
output of the carry computation is fed to the next adder (either to adder1
in the same ALM or to adder0 of the next ALM in the LAB) via a
dedicated connection called the shared arithmetic chain. This shared
arithmetic chain can significantly improve the performance of an adder
tree by reducing the number of summation stages required to implement
an adder tree. Figure 2–13 shows the ALM in shared arithmetic mode.
2–18 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
Figure 2–13. ALM in Shared Arithmetic Mode
Note to Figure 2–13:
(1) Inputs dataf0 and dataf1 are available for register packing in shared arithmetic mode.
Adder trees can be found in many different applications. For example, the
summation of the partial products in a logic-based multiplier can be
implemented in a tree structure. Another example is a correlator function
that can use a large adder tree to sum filtered data samples in a given time
frame to recover or to de-spread data which was transmitted utilizing
spread spectrum technology.
An example of a three-bit add operation utilizing the shared arithmetic
mode is shown in Figure 2–14. The partial sum (S[2..0]) and the
partial carry (C[2..0]) is obtained using the LUTs, while the result
(R[2..0]) is computed using the dedicated adders.
datae0
carry_in
shared_arith_in
shared_arith_out
carry_out
dataa
datab
datac
datad
datae1
DQ
DQ
To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
reg0
reg1
To general or
local routing
To general or
local routing
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
4-Input
LUT
Altera Corporation 2–19
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–14. Example of a 3-bit Add Utilizing Shared Arithmetic Mode
Shared Arithmetic Chain
In addition to the dedicated carry chain routing, the shared arithmetic
chain available in shared arithmetic mode allows the ALM to implement
a three-input add. This significantly reduces the resources necessary to
implement large adder trees or correlator functions.
The shared arithmetic chains can begin in either the first or fifth ALM in
an LAB. The Quartus II Compiler creates shared arithmetic chains longer
than 16 (8 ALMs in arithmetic or shared arithmetic mode) by linking
LABs together automatically. For enhanced fitting, a long shared
carry_in = '0'
shared_arith_in = '0'
Z0
Y0
X0
Binary Add
Decimal
Equivalents
+
Z1
X1
R0
C0
S0
S1
S2
C1
C2
'0'
R1
Y1
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
Z2
Y2
X2
R2
R3
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
3-Input
LUT
ALM 1
3-Bit Add Example ALM Implementation
ALM 2
X2 X1 X0
Y2 Y1 Y0
Z2 Z1 Z0
S2 S1 S0
C2 C1 C0
R3 R2 R1 R0
+
+
1 1 0
1 0 1
0 1 0
0 0 1
1 1 0
1 1 0 1
+
+
6
5
2
1
2 x 6
13
+
2nd stage add is
implemented in adders.
1st stage add is
implemented in LUTs.
2–20 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Adaptive Logic Modules
arithmetic chain runs vertically allowing fast horizontal connections to
TriMatrix memory and DSP blocks. A shared arithmetic chain can
continue as far as a full column.
Similar to the carry chains, the shared arithmetic chains are also top- or
bottom-half bypassable. This capability allows the shared arithmetic
chain to cascade through half of the ALMs in a LAB while leaving the
other half available for narrower fan-in functionality. Every other LAB
column is top-half bypassable, while the other LAB columns are bottom-
half bypassable.
See the “MultiTrack Interconnect” on page 2–22 section for more
information on shared arithmetic chain interconnect.
Register Chain
In addition to the general routing outputs, the ALMs in an LAB have
register chain outputs. The register chain routing allows registers in the
same LAB to be cascaded together. The register chain interconnect allows
an LAB to use LUTs for a single combinational function and the registers
to be used for an unrelated shift register implementation. These resources
speed up connections between ALMs while saving local interconnect
resources (see Figure 2–15). The Quartus II Compiler automatically takes
advantage of these resources to improve utilization and performance.
Altera Corporation 2–21
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–15. Register Chain within an LAB Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–15:
(1) The combinational or adder logic can be utilized to implement an unrelated, un-registered function.
See the “MultiTrack Interconnect” on page 2–22 section for more
information on register chain interconnect.
DQ
To general or
local routing
reg0
To general or
local routing
reg_chain_in
adder0
DQ
To general or
local routing
reg1
To general or
local routing
adder1
DQ
To general or
local routing
reg0
To general or
local routing
reg_chain_out
adder0
DQ
To general or
local routing
reg1
To general or
local routing
adder1
From Previous ALM
Within The LAB
To Next ALM
within the LAB
Combinational
Logic
Combinational
Logic
2–22 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
MultiTrack Interconnect
Clear & Preset Logic Control
LAB-wide signals control the logic for the register's clear and load/preset
signals. The ALM directly supports an asynchronous clear and preset
function. The register preset is achieved through the asynchronous load
of a logic high. The direct asynchronous preset does not require a NOT-
gate push-back technique. Stratix II devices support simultaneous
asynchronous load/preset, and clear signals. An asynchronous clear
signal takes precedence if both signals are asserted simultaneously. Each
LAB supports up to two clears and one load/preset signal.
In addition to the clear and load/preset ports, Stratix II devices provide a
device-wide reset pin (DEV_CLRn) that resets all registers in the device.
An option set before compilation in the Quartus II software controls this
pin. This device-wide reset overrides all other control signals.
MultiTrack
Interconnect
In the Stratix II architecture, connections between ALMs, TriMatrix
memory, DSP blocks, and device I/O pins are provided by the MultiTrack
interconnect structure with DirectDriveTM technology. The MultiTrack
interconnect consists of continuous, performance-optimized routing lines
of different lengths and speeds used for inter- and intra-design block
connectivity. The Quartus II Compiler automatically places critical design
paths on faster interconnects to improve design performance.
DirectDrive technology is a deterministic routing technology that ensures
identical routing resource usage for any function regardless of placement
in the device. The MultiTrack interconnect and DirectDrive technology
simplify the integration stage of block-based designing by eliminating the
re-optimization cycles that typically follow design changes and
additions.
The MultiTrack interconnect consists of row and column interconnects
that span fixed distances. A routing structure with fixed length resources
for all devices allows predictable and repeatable performance when
migrating through different device densities. Dedicated row
interconnects route signals to and from LABs, DSP blocks, and TriMatrix
memory in the same row. These row resources include:
Direct link interconnects between LABs and adjacent blocks
R4 interconnects traversing four blocks to the right or left
R24 row interconnects for high-speed access across the length of the
device
Altera Corporation 2–23
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The direct link interconnect allows an LAB, DSP block, or TriMatrix
memory block to drive into the local interconnect of its left and right
neighbors and then back into itself. This provides fast communication
between adjacent LABs and/or blocks without using row interconnect
resources.
The R4 interconnects span four LABs, three LABs and one M512 RAM
block, two LABs and one M4K RAM block, or two LABs and one DSP
block to the right or left of a source LAB. These resources are used for fast
row connections in a four-LAB region. Every LAB has its own set of R4
interconnects to drive either left or right. Figure 2–16 shows R4
interconnect connections from an LAB. R4 interconnects can drive and be
driven by DSP blocks and RAM blocks and row IOEs. For LAB
interfacing, a primary LAB or LAB neighbor can drive a given R4
interconnect. For R4 interconnects that drive to the right, the primary
LAB and right neighbor can drive on to the interconnect. For R4
interconnects that drive to the left, the primary LAB and its left neighbor
can drive on to the interconnect. R4 interconnects can drive other R4
interconnects to extend the range of LABs they can drive. R4
interconnects can also drive C4 and C16 interconnects for connections
from one row to another. Additionally, R4 interconnects can drive R24
interconnects.
Figure 2–16. R4 Interconnect Connections Notes (1), (2), (3)
Notes to Figure 2–16:
(1) C4 and C16 interconnects can drive R4 interconnects.
(2) This pattern is repeated for every LAB in the LAB row.
(3) The LABs in Figure 2–16 show the 16 possible logical outputs per LAB.
Primary
LAB (2)
R4 Interconnect
Driving Left
Adjacent LAB can
Drive onto Another
LAB's R4 Interconnect
C4 and C16
Column Interconnects (1)
R4 Interconnect
Driving Right
LAB
Neighbor
LAB
Neighbor
2–24 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
MultiTrack Interconnect
R24 row interconnects span 24 LABs and provide the fastest resource for
long row connections between LABs, TriMatrix memory, DSP blocks, and
Row IOEs. The R24 row interconnects can cross M-RAM blocks. R24 row
interconnects drive to other row or column interconnects at every fourth
LAB and do not drive directly to LAB local interconnects. R24 row
interconnects drive LAB local interconnects via R4 and C4 interconnects.
R24 interconnects can drive R24, R4, C16, and C4 interconnects.
The column interconnect operates similarly to the row interconnect and
vertically routes signals to and from LABs, TriMatrix memory, DSP
blocks, and IOEs. Each column of LABs is served by a dedicated column
interconnect. These column resources include:
Shared arithmetic chain interconnects in an LAB
Carry chain interconnects in an LAB and from LAB to LAB
Register chain interconnects in an LAB
C4 interconnects traversing a distance of four blocks in up and down
direction
C16 column interconnects for high-speed vertical routing through
the device
Stratix II devices include an enhanced interconnect structure in LABs for
routing shared arithmetic chains and carry chains for efficient arithmetic
functions. The register chain connection allows the register output of one
ALM to connect directly to the register input of the next ALM in the LAB
for fast shift registers. These ALM to ALM connections bypass the local
interconnect. The Quartus II Compiler automatically takes advantage of
these resources to improve utilization and performance. Figure 2–17
shows the shared arithmetic chain, carry chain and register chain
interconnects.
Altera Corporation 2–25
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–17. Shared Arithmetic Chain, Carry Chain & Register Chain
Interconnects
The C4 interconnects span four LABs, M512, or M4K blocks up or down
from a source LAB. Every LAB has its own set of C4 interconnects to drive
either up or down. Figure 2–18 shows the C4 interconnect connections
from an LAB in a column. The C4 interconnects can drive and be driven
by all types of architecture blocks, including DSP blocks, TriMatrix
memory blocks, and column and row IOEs. For LAB interconnection, a
primary LAB or its LAB neighbor can drive a given C4 interconnect. C4
interconnects can drive each other to extend their range as well as drive
row interconnects for column-to-column connections.
ALM 1
ALM 2
ALM 3
ALM 4
ALM 5
ALM 6
ALM 8
ALM 7
Carry Chain & Shared
Arithmetic Chain
Routing to Adjacent ALM
Local
Interconnect
Register Chain
Routing to Adjacent
ALM's Register Inpu
Local Interconnect
Routing Among ALMs
in the LAB
2–26 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
MultiTrack Interconnect
Figure 2–18. C4 Interconnect Connections Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–18:
(1) Each C4 interconnect can drive either up or down four rows.
C4 Interconnect
Drives Local and R4
Interconnects
up to Four Rows
Adjacent LAB can
drive onto neighboring
LAB's C4 interconnect
C4 Interconnect
Driving Up
C4 Interconnect
Driving Down
LAB
Row
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Altera Corporation 2–27
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
C16 column interconnects span a length of 16 LABs and provide the
fastest resource for long column connections between LABs, TriMatrix
memory blocks, DSP blocks, and IOEs. C16 interconnects can cross
M-RAM blocks and also drive to row and column interconnects at every
fourth LAB. C16 interconnects drive LAB local interconnects via C4 and
R4 interconnects and do not drive LAB local interconnects directly.
All embedded blocks communicate with the logic array similar to LAB-
to-LAB interfaces. Each block (that is, TriMatrix memory and DSP blocks)
connects to row and column interconnects and has local interconnect
regions driven by row and column interconnects. These blocks also have
direct link interconnects for fast connections to and from a neighboring
LAB. All blocks are fed by the row LAB clocks, labclk[5..0].
Table 2–2 shows the Stratix II device’s routing scheme.
Table 2–2. Stratix II Device Routing Scheme (Part 1 of 2)
Source
Destination
Shared Arithmetic Chain
Carry Chain
Register Chain
Local Interconnect
Direct Link Interconnect
R4 Interconnect
R24 Interconnect
C4 Interconnect
C16 Interconnect
ALM
M512 RAM Block
M4K RAM Block
M-RAM Block
DSP Blocks
Column IOE
Row IOE
Shared arithmetic chain v
Carry chain v
Register chain v
Local interconnect vvvvvvv
Direct link interconnect v
R4 interconnect v vvvv
R24 interconnect vvvv
C4 interconnect vvv
C16 interconnect vvvv
ALM vvvvvv v
M512 RAM block vvv v
M4K RAM block vvv v
M-RAM block vvvv
DSP blocks vv v
2–28 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
TriMatrix Memory
TriMatrix
Memory
TriMatrix memory consists of three types of RAM blocks: M512, M4K,
and M-RAM. Although these memory blocks are different, they can all
implement various types of memory with or without parity, including
true dual-port, simple dual-port, and single-port RAM, ROM, and FIFO
buffers. Table 2–3 shows the size and features of the different RAM
blocks.
Column IOE vvv
Row IOE vvvv
Table 2–2. Stratix II Device Routing Scheme (Part 2 of 2)
Source
Destination
Shared Arithmetic Chain
Carry Chain
Register Chain
Local Interconnect
Direct Link Interconnect
R4 Interconnect
R24 Interconnect
C4 Interconnect
C16 Interconnect
ALM
M512 RAM Block
M4K RAM Block
M-RAM Block
DSP Blocks
Column IOE
Row IOE
Table 2–3. TriMatrix Memory Features (Part 1 of 2)
Memory Feature M512 RAM Block
(32 × 18 Bits)
M4K RAM Block
(128 × 36 Bits)
M-RAM Block
(4K × 144 Bits)
Maximum performance 500 MHz 550 MHz 420 MHz
True dual-port memory vv
Simple dual-port memory vvv
Single-port memory vvv
Shift register vv
ROM vv(1)
FIFO buffer vvv
Pack mode vv
Byte enable vvv
Address clock enable vv
Parity bits vvv
Mixed clock mode vvv
Memory initialization (.mif)vv
Altera Corporation 2–29
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Memory Block Size
TriMatrix memory provides three different memory sizes for efficient
application support. The Quartus II software automatically partitions the
user-defined memory into the embedded memory blocks using the most
efficient size combinations. You can also manually assign the memory to
a specific block size or a mixture of block sizes.
When applied to input registers, the asynchronous clear signal for the
TriMatrix embedded memory immediately clears the input registers.
However, the output of the memory block does not show the effects until
the next clock edge. When applied to output registers, the asynchronous
clear signal clears the output registers and the effects are seen
immediately.
Simple dual-port memory
mixed width support vvv
True dual-port memory
mixed width support vv
Power-up conditions Outputs cleared Outputs cleared Outputs unknown
Register clears Output registers Output registers Output registers
Mixed-port read-during-write Unknown output/old data Unknown output/old data Unknown output
Configurations 512 × 1
256 × 2
128 × 4
64 × 8
64 × 9
32 × 16
32 × 18
4K × 1
2K × 2
1K × 4
512 × 8
512 × 9
256 × 16
256 × 18
128 × 32
128 × 36
64K × 8
64K × 9
32K × 16
32K × 18
16K × 32
16K × 36
8K × 64
8K × 72
4K × 128
4K × 144
Notes to Tab l e 2 3 :
(1) The M-RAM block does not support memory initializations. However, the M-RAM block can emulate a ROM
function using a dual-port RAM bock. The Stratix II device must write to the dual-port memory once and then
disable the write-enable ports afterwards.
Table 2–3. TriMatrix Memory Features (Part 2 of 2)
Memory Feature M512 RAM Block
(32 × 18 Bits)
M4K RAM Block
(128 × 36 Bits)
M-RAM Block
(4K × 144 Bits)
2–30 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
TriMatrix Memory
M512 RAM Block
The M512 RAM block is a simple dual-port memory block and is useful
for implementing small FIFO buffers, DSP, and clock domain transfer
applications. Each block contains 576 RAM bits (including parity bits).
M512 RAM blocks can be configured in the following modes:
Simple dual-port RAM
Single-port RAM
FIFO
ROM
Shift register
1Violating the setup or hold time on the memory block address
registers could corrupt memory contents. This applies to both
read and write operations.
When configured as RAM or ROM, you can use an initialization file to
pre-load the memory contents.
M512 RAM blocks can have different clocks on its inputs and outputs.
The wren, datain, and write address registers are all clocked together
from one of the two clocks feeding the block. The read address, rden, and
output registers can be clocked by either of the two clocks driving the
block. This allows the RAM block to operate in read/write or
input/output clock modes. Only the output register can be bypassed. The
six labclk signals or local interconnect can drive the inclock,
outclock, wren, rden, and outclr signals. Because of the advanced
interconnect between the LAB and M512 RAM blocks, ALMs can also
control the wren and rden signals and the RAM clock, clock enable, and
asynchronous clear signals. Figure 2–19 shows the M512 RAM block
control signal generation logic.
The RAM blocks in Stratix II devices have local interconnects to allow
ALMs and interconnects to drive into RAM blocks. The M512 RAM block
local interconnect is driven by the R4, C4, and direct link interconnects
from adjacent LABs. The M512 RAM blocks can communicate with LABs
on either the left or right side through these row interconnects or with
LAB columns on the left or right side with the column interconnects. The
M512 RAM block has up to 16 direct link input connections from the left
adjacent LABs and another 16 from the right adjacent LAB. M512 RAM
outputs can also connect to left and right LABs through direct link
interconnect. The M512 RAM block has equal opportunity for access and
performance to and from LABs on either its left or right side. Figure 2–20
shows the M512 RAM block to logic array interface.
Altera Corporation 2–31
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–19. M512 RAM Block Control Signals
inclocken
outclockinclock
outclocken
rden
wren
Dedicated
Row LAB
Clocks
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect outclr
6
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
2–32 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
TriMatrix Memory
Figure 2–20. M512 RAM Block LAB Row Interface
M4K RAM Blocks
The M4K RAM block includes support for true dual-port RAM. The M4K
RAM block is used to implement buffers for a wide variety of applications
such as storing processor code, implementing lookup schemes, and
implementing larger memory applications. Each block contains 4,608
RAM bits (including parity bits). M4K RAM blocks can be configured in
the following modes:
True dual-port RAM
Simple dual-port RAM
Single-port RAM
FIFO
ROM
Shift register
When configured as RAM or ROM, you can use an initialization file to
pre-load the memory contents.
dataout
M512 RAM
Block
datain
clocks
16
Direct link
interconnect
from adjacent LAB
Direct link
interconnect
to adjacent LAB
Direct link
interconnect
from adjacent LAB
Direct link
interconnect
to adjacent LAB
M512 RAM Block Local
Interconnect Region
C4 Interconnect R4 Interconnect
control
signals address
LAB Row Clocks
2
6
Altera Corporation 2–33
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The M4K RAM blocks allow for different clocks on their inputs and
outputs. Either of the two clocks feeding the block can clock M4K RAM
block registers (renwe, address, byte enable, datain, and output registers).
Only the output register can be bypassed. The six labclk signals or local
interconnects can drive the control signals for the A and B ports of the
M4K RAM block. ALMs can also control the clock_a, clock_b,
renwe_a, renwe_b, clr_a, clr_b, clocken_a, and clocken_b
signals, as shown in Figure 2–21.
The R4, C4, and direct link interconnects from adjacent LABs drive the
M4K RAM block local interconnect. The M4K RAM blocks can
communicate with LABs on either the left or right side through these row
resources or with LAB columns on either the right or left with the column
resources. Up to 16 direct link input connections to the M4K RAM Block
are possible from the left adjacent LABs and another 16 possible from the
right adjacent LAB. M4K RAM block outputs can also connect to left and
right LABs through direct link interconnect. Figure 2–22 shows the M4K
RAM block to logic array interface.
Figure 2–21. M4K RAM Block Control Signals
clock_b
clocken_aclock_a
clocken_b aclr_b
aclr_a
Dedicated
Row LAB
Clocks
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
renwe_b
renwe_a
6
2–34 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
TriMatrix Memory
Figure 2–22. M4K RAM Block LAB Row Interface
M-RAM Block
The largest TriMatrix memory block, the M-RAM block, is useful for
applications where a large volume of data must be stored on-chip. Each
block contains 589,824 RAM bits (including parity bits). The M-RAM
block can be configured in the following modes:
True dual-port RAM
Simple dual-port RAM
Single-port RAM
FIFO
You cannot use an initialization file to initialize the contents of an M-RAM
block. All M-RAM block contents power up to an undefined value. Only
synchronous operation is supported in the M-RAM block, so all inputs
are registered. Output registers can be bypassed.
dataout
M4K RAM
Block
datain
address
16
36
Direct link
interconnect
from adjacent LAB
Direct link
interconnect
to adjacent LAB
Direct link
interconnect
from adjacent LAB
Direct link
interconnect
to adjacent LAB
M4K RAM Block Local
Interconnect Region
C4 Interconnect R4 Interconnect
LAB Row Clocks
clocks
byte
enable
control
signals
6
Altera Corporation 2–35
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Similar to all RAM blocks, M-RAM blocks can have different clocks on
their inputs and outputs. Either of the two clocks feeding the block can
clock M-RAM block registers (renwe, address, byte enable, datain, and
output registers). The output register can be bypassed. The six labclk
signals or local interconnect can drive the control signals for the A and B
ports of the M-RAM block. ALMs can also control the clock_a,
clock_b, renwe_a, renwe_b, clr_a, clr_b, clocken_a, and
clocken_b signals as shown in Figure 2–23.
Figure 2–23. M-RAM Block Control Signals
The R4, R24, C4, and direct link interconnects from adjacent LABs on
either the right or left side drive the M-RAM block local interconnect. Up
to 16 direct link input connections to the M-RAM block are possible from
the left adjacent LABs and another 16 possible from the right adjacent
LAB. M-RAM block outputs can also connect to left and right LABs
through direct link interconnect. Figure 2–24 shows an example floorplan
for the EP2S130 device and the location of the M-RAM interfaces.
Figures 2–25 and 2–26 show the interface between the M-RAM block and
the logic array.
clock_a
clock_b
clocken_a
clocken_b
aclr_a
aclr_b
Dedicated
Row LAB
Clocks
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
renwe_a
renwe_b
6
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
2–36 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
TriMatrix Memory
Figure 2–24. EP2S130 Device with M-RAM Interface Locations Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–24:
(1) The device shown is an EP2S130 device. The number and position of M-RAM blocks varies in other devices.
DSP
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
M4K
Blocks
M512
Blocks
LABs
M-RAM
Block
M-RAM
Block
M-RAM
Block
M-RAM
Block
M-RAM
Block
M-RAM
Block
M-RAM blocks interface to
LABs on right and left sides for
easy access to horizontal I/O pins
Altera Corporation 2–37
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–25. M-RAM Block LAB Row Interface Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–25:
(1) Only R24 and C16 interconnects cross the M-RAM block boundaries.
M-RAM Block
Port BPort A
Row Unit Interface Allows LAB
Rows to Drive Port B Datain,
Dataout, Address and Control
Signals to and from M-RAM Block
Row Unit Interface Allows LAB
Rows to Drive Port A Datain,
Dataout, Address and Control
Signals to and from M-RAM Block
LABs in Row
M-RAM Boundary
LABs in Row
M-RAM Boundary
LAB Interface
Blocks
L0
L1
L2
L3
L4
L5
R0
R1
R2
R3
R4
R5
2–38 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
TriMatrix Memory
Figure 2–26. M-RAM Row Unit Interface to Interconnect
Table 2–4 shows the input and output data signal connections along with
the address and control signal input connections to the row unit interfaces
(L0 to L5 and R0 to R5).
LAB
Row Interface Block
M-RAM Block
16
Up to 28
datain_a[ ]
addressa[ ]
addr_ena_a
renwe_a
byteenaA[ ]
clocken_a
clock_a
aclr_a
M-RAM Block to
LAB Row Interface
Block Interconnect Region
R4 and R24 InterconnectsC4 Interconnect
Direct Link
Interconnects
dataout_a[ ]
Up to 16
Altera Corporation 2–39
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
fSee the TriMatrix Embedded Memory Blocks in Stratix II & Stratix II GX
Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the
Stratix II GX Device Handbook for more information on TriMatrix
memory.
Table 2–4. M-RAM Row Interface Unit Signals
Unit Interface Block Input Signals Output Signals
L0 datain_a[14..0]
byteena_a[1..0]
dataout_a[11..0]
L1 datain_a[29..15]
byteena_a[3..2]
dataout_a[23..12]
L2 datain_a[35..30]
addressa[4..0]
addr_ena_a
clock_a
clocken_a
renwe_a
aclr_a
dataout_a[35..24]
L3 addressa[15..5]
datain_a[41..36]
dataout_a[47..36]
L4 datain_a[56..42]
byteena_a[5..4]
dataout_a[59..48]
L5 datain_a[71..57]
byteena_a[7..6]
dataout_a[71..60]
R0 datain_b[14..0]
byteena_b[1..0]
dataout_b[11..0]
R1 datain_b[29..15]
byteena_b[3..2]
dataout_b[23..12]
R2 datain_b[35..30]
addressb[4..0]
addr_ena_b
clock_b
clocken_b
renwe_b
aclr_b
dataout_b[35..24]
R3 addressb[15..5]
datain_b[41..36]
dataout_b[47..36]
R4 datain_b[56..42]
byteena_b[5..4]
dataout_b[59..48]
R5 datain_b[71..57]
byteena_b[7..6]
dataout_b[71..60]
2–40 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Digital Signal Processing Block
Digital Signal
Processing
Block
The most commonly used DSP functions are FIR filters, complex FIR
filters, IIR filters, fast Fourier transform (FFT) functions, direct cosine
transform (DCT) functions, and correlators. All of these use the multiplier
as the fundamental building block. Additionally, some applications need
specialized operations such as multiply-add and multiply-accumulate
operations. Stratix II devices provide DSP blocks to meet the arithmetic
requirements of these functions.
Each Stratix II device has from two to four columns of DSP blocks to
efficiently implement DSP functions faster than ALM-based
implementations. Stratix II devices have up to 24 DSP blocks per column
(see Table 2–5). Each DSP block can be configured to support up to:
Eight 9 × 9-bit multipliers
Four 18 × 18-bit multipliers
One 36 × 36-bit multiplier
As indicated, the Stratix II DSP block can support one 36 × 36-bit
multiplier in a single DSP block. This is true for any combination of
signed, unsigned, or mixed sign multiplications.
1This list only shows functions that can fit into a single DSP block.
Multiple DSP blocks can support larger multiplication
functions.
Altera Corporation 2–41
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–27 shows one of the columns with surrounding LAB rows.
Figure 2–27. DSP Blocks Arranged in Columns
DSP Block
Column
4 LAB
Rows
DSP Block
2–42 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Digital Signal Processing Block
Table 2–5 shows the number of DSP blocks in each Stratix II device.
DSP block multipliers can optionally feed an adder/subtractor or
accumulator in the block depending on the configuration. This makes
routing to ALMs easier, saves ALM routing resources, and increases
performance, because all connections and blocks are in the DSP block.
Additionally, the DSP block input registers can efficiently implement shift
registers for FIR filter applications, and DSP blocks support Q1.15 format
rounding and saturation.
Figure 2–28 shows the top-level diagram of the DSP block configured for
18 × 18-bit multiplier mode.
Table 2–5. DSP Blocks in Stratix II Devices Note (1)
Device DSP Blocks Total 9 × 9
Multipliers
Total 18 × 18
Multipliers
Total 36 × 36
Multipliers
EP2S15 12 96 48 12
EP2S30 16 128 64 16
EP2S60 36 288 144 36
EP2S90 48 384 192 48
EP2S130 63 504 252 63
EP2S180 96 768 384 96
Note to Ta b l e 2 5 :
(1) Each device has either the numbers of 9 × 9-, 18 × 18-, or 36 × 36-bit multipliers
shown. The total number of multipliers for each device is not the sum of all the
multipliers.
Altera Corporation 2–43
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–28. DSP Block Diagram for 18 × 18-Bit Configuration
Adder/
Subtractor/
Accumulator
1
Adder
Multiplier Block
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
PRN
CLRN
DQ
ENA
Summation
Block
Adder Output Block
Adder/
Subtractor/
Accumulator
2
Q1.15
Round/
Saturate
Q1.15
Round/
Saturate
Q1.15
Round/
Saturate
Q1.15
Round/
Saturate
to MultiTrack
Interconnect
CLRN
DQ
ENA
From the row
interface block
Optional Serial Shift
Register Inputs from
Previous DSP Block
Optional Serial Shift
Register Outputs to
Next DSP Block
in the Column
Optional Input Register
Stage with Parallel Input or
Shift Register Configuration
Optional Pipline
Register Stage
Summation Stage
for Adding Four
Multipliers Together
Optional Stage Configurable
as Accumulator or Dynamic
Adder/Subtractor
Output
Selection
Multiplexer
Q1.15
Round/
Saturate
Q1.15
Round/
Saturate
2–44 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Digital Signal Processing Block
Modes of Operation
The adder, subtractor, and accumulate functions of a DSP block have four
modes of operation:
Simple multiplier
Multiply-accumulator
Two-multipliers adder
Four-multipliers adder
Table 2–6 shows the different number of multipliers possible in each DSP
block mode according to size. These modes allow the DSP blocks to
implement numerous applications for DSP including FFTs, complex FIR,
FIR, and 2D FIR filters, equalizers, IIR, correlators, matrix multiplication
and many other functions. The DSP blocks also support mixed modes
and mixed multiplier sizes in the same block. For example, half of one
DSP block can implement one 18 × 18-bit multiplier in multiply-
accumulator mode, while the other half of the DSP block implements four
9 × 9-bit multipliers in simple multiplier mode.
DSP Block Interface
Stratix II device DSP block input registers can generate a shift register that
can cascade down in the same DSP block column. Dedicated connections
between DSP blocks provide fast connections between the shift register
inputs to cascade the shift register chains. You can cascade registers
within multiple DSP blocks for 9 × 9- or 18 × 18-bit FIR filters larger than
four taps, with additional adder stages implemented in ALMs. If the DSP
block is configured as 36 × 36 bits, the adder, subtractor, or accumulator
stages are implemented in ALMs. Each DSP block can route the shift
register chain out of the block to cascade multiple columns of DSP blocks.
Table 2–6. Multiplier Size & Configurations per DSP Block
DSP Block Mode 9 × 9 18 × 18 36 × 36
Multiplier Eight multipliers with
eight product outputs
Four multipliers with four
product outputs
One multiplier with one
product output
Multiply-accumulator - Two 52-bit multiply-
accumulate blocks
-
Two-multipliers adder Four two-multiplier adder
(two 9 × 9 complex
multiply)
Two two-multiplier adder
(one 18 × 18 complex
multiply)
-
Four-multipliers adder Two four-multiplier adder One four-multiplier adder -
Altera Corporation 2–45
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The DSP block is divided into four block units that interface with four
LAB rows on the left and right. Each block unit can be considered one
complete 18 × 18-bit multiplier with 36 inputs and 36 outputs. A local
interconnect region is associated with each DSP block. Like an LAB, this
interconnect region can be fed with 16 direct link interconnects from the
LAB to the left or right of the DSP block in the same row. R4 and C4
routing resources can access the DSP block's local interconnect region.
The outputs also work similarly to LAB outputs as well. Eighteen outputs
from the DSP block can drive to the left LAB through direct link
interconnects and eighteen can drive to the right LAB though direct link
interconnects. All 36 outputs can drive to R4 and C4 routing
interconnects. Outputs can drive right- or left-column routing.
Figures 2–29 and 2–30 show the DSP block interfaces to LAB rows.
Figure 2–29. DSP Block Interconnect Interface
A1[17..0]
B1[17..0]
A2[17..0]
B2[17..0]
A3[17..0]
B3[17..0]
A4[17..0]
B4[17..0]
OA[17..0]
OB[17..0]
OC[17..0]
OD[17..0]
OE[17..0]
OF[17..0]
OG[17..0]
OH[17..0]
DSP Block
R4, C4 & Direct
Link Interconnects
R4, C4 & Direct
Link Interconnects
2–46 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Digital Signal Processing Block
Figure 2–30. DSP Block Interface to Interconnect
A bus of 44 control signals feeds the entire DSP block. These signals
include clocks, asynchronous clears, clock enables, signed/unsigned
control signals, addition and subtraction control signals, rounding and
saturation control signals, and accumulator synchronous loads. The clock
signals are routed from LAB row clocks and are generated from specific
LAB rows at the DSP block interface.
LAB LAB
Row Interface
Block
DSP Block
Row Structure
16
OA[17..0]
OB[17..0]
A[17..0]
B[17..0]
DSP Block to
LAB Row Interface
Block Interconnect Region
36 Inputs per Row 36 Outputs per Row
R4 Interconnect
C4 Interconnect
Direct Link Interconnect
from Adjacent LAB
Direct Link Outputs
to Adjacent LABs
Direct Link Interconnect
from Adjacent LAB
36
36
36
36
Control
12
16
18
Altera Corporation 2–47
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The LAB row source for control signals, data inputs, and outputs is
shown in Table 27.
fSee the DSP Blocks in Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter in
volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the Stratix II GX Device
Handbook, for more information on DSP blocks.
Table 2–7. DSP Block Signal Sources & Destinations
LAB Row at
Interface Control Signals Generated Data Inputs Data Outputs
0clock0
aclr0
ena0
mult01_saturate
addnsub1_round/ accum_round
addnsub1
signa
sourcea
sourceb
A1[17..0]
B1[17..0]
OA[17..0]
OB[17..0]
1clock1
aclr1
ena1
accum_saturate
mult01_round
accum_sload
sourcea
sourceb
mode0
A2[17..0]
B2[17..0]
OC[17..0]
OD[17..0]
2clock2
aclr2
ena2
mult23_saturate
addnsub3_round/ accum_round
addnsub3
sign_b
sourcea
sourceb
A3[17..0]
B3[17..0]
OE[17..0]
OF[17..0]
3clock3
aclr3
ena3
accum_saturate
mult23_round
accum_sload
sourcea
sourceb
mode1
A4[17..0]
B4[17..0]
OG[17..0]
OH[17..0]
2–48 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
PLLs & Clock
Networks
Stratix II devices provide a hierarchical clock structure and multiple PLLs
with advanced features. The large number of clocking resources in
combination with the clock synthesis precision provided by enhanced
and fast PLLs provides a complete clock management solution.
Global & Hierarchical Clocking
Stratix II devices provide 16 dedicated global clock networks and
32 regional clock networks (eight per device quadrant). These clocks are
organized into a hierarchical clock structure that allows for up to
24 clocks per device region with low skew and delay. This hierarchical
clocking scheme provides up to 48 unique clock domains in Stratix II
devices.
There are 16 dedicated clock pins (CLK[15..0]) to drive either the global
or regional clock networks. Four clock pins drive each side of the device,
as shown in Figures 2–31 and 2–32. Internal logic and enhanced and fast
PLL outputs can also drive the global and regional clock networks. Each
global and regional clock has a clock control block, which controls the
selection of the clock source and dynamically enables/disables the clock
to reduce power consumption. Table 2–8 shows global and regional clock
features.
Global Clock Network
These clocks drive throughout the entire device, feeding all device
quadrants. The global clock networks can be used as clock sources for all
resources in the device-IOEs, ALMs, DSP blocks, and all memory blocks.
These resources can also be used for control signals, such as clock enables
and synchronous or asynchronous clears fed from the external pin. The
Table 2–8. Global & Regional Clock Features
Feature Global Clocks Regional Clocks
Number per device 16 32
Number available per
quadrant
16 8
Sources CLK pins, PLL outputs,
or internal logic
CLK pins, PLL outputs,
or internal logic
Dynamic clock source
selection v (1)
Dynamic enable/disable vv
Note to Ta b l e 2 8 :
(1) Dynamic source clock selection is supported for selecting between CLKp pins and
PLL outputs only.
Altera Corporation 2–49
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
global clock networks can also be driven by internal logic for internally
generated global clocks and asynchronous clears, clock enables, or other
control signals with large fanout. Figure 2–31 shows the 16 dedicated CLK
pins driving global clock networks.
Figure 2–31. Global Clocking
Regional Clock Network
There are eight regional clock networks RCLK[7..0] in each quadrant of
the Stratix II device that are driven by the dedicated CLK[15..0] input
pins, by PLL outputs, or by internal logic. The regional clock networks
provide the lowest clock delay and skew for logic contained in a single
quadrant. The CLK clock pins symmetrically drive the RCLK networks in
a particular quadrant, as shown in Figure 2–32.
Global Clock [15..0]
CLK[15..12]
CLK[3..0]
CLK[7..4]
CLK[11..8]
Global Clock [15..0]
2–50 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
Figure 2–32. Regional Clocks
Dual-Regional Clock Network
A single source (CLK pin or PLL output) can generate a dual-regional
clock by driving two regional clock network lines in adjacent quadrants
(one from each quadrant). This allows logic that spans multiple
quadrants to utilize the same low skew clock. The routing of this clock
signal on an entire side has approximately the same speed but slightly
higher clock skew when compared with a clock signal that drives a single
quadrant. Internal logic-array routing can also drive a dual-regional
clock. Clock pins and enhanced PLL outputs on the top and bottom can
drive horizontal dual-regional clocks. Clock pins and fast PLL outputs on
the left and right can drive vertical dual-regional clocks, as shown in
Figure 2–33. Corner PLLs cannot drive dual-regional clocks.
RCLK[3..0]
RCLK[7..4]
RCLK[11..8] RCLK[15..12]
RCLK[31..28] RCLK[27..24]
RCLK[19..16]
RCLK[23..20]
CLK[15..12]
CLK[3..0]
CLK[7..4]
CLK[11..8]
Regional Clocks Only Drive a Device
Quadrant from Specified CLK Pins,
PLLs or Core Logic within that Quadrant
Altera Corporation 2–51
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–33. Dual-Regional Clocks
Combined Resources
Within each quadrant, there are 24 distinct dedicated clocking resources
consisting of 16 global clock lines and eight regional clock lines.
Multiplexers are used with these clocks to form busses to drive LAB row
clocks, column IOE clocks, or row IOE clocks. Another multiplexer is
used at the LAB level to select three of the six row clocks to feed the ALM
registers in the LAB (see Figure 2–34).
Figure 2–34. Hierarchical Clock Networks Per Quadrant
Clock Pins or PLL Clock Outputs
Can Drive Dual-Regional Network
CLK[15..12]
CLK[11..8]
CLK[7..4]
CLK[3..0]
PLLsPLLs
Clock Pins or PLL Clock
Outputs Can Drive
Dual-Regional Network
CLK[15..12]
CLK[11..8]
CLK[7..4]
CLK[3..0]
Clock [23..0]
Column I/O Cell
IO_CLK[7..0]
Lab Row Clock [5..0]
Row I/O Cell
IO_CLK[7..0]
Global Clock Network [15..0]
Regional Clock Network [7..0]
Clocks Available
to a Quadrant
or Half-Quadrant
2–52 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
IOE clocks have row and column block regions that are clocked by eight
I/O clock signals chosen from the 24 quadrant clock resources.
Figures 2–35 and 2–36 show the quadrant relationship to the I/O clock
regions.
Figure 2–35. EP2S15 & EP2S30 Device I/O Clock Groups
IO_CLKC[7:0]
IO_CLKF[7:0] IO_CLKE[7:0]
IO_CLKA[7:0] IO_CLKB[7:0]
IO_CLKD[7:0]
IO_CLKH[7:0]
IO_CLKG[7:0]
8
8
24 Clocks in
the Quadrant
24 Clocks in
the Quadrant
24 Clocks in
the Quadrant
24 Clocks in
the Quadrant
8
8
8
8
8 8
I/O Clock Regions
Altera Corporation 2–53
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–36. EP2S60, EP2S90, EP2S130 & EP2S180 Device I/O Clock Groups
You can use the Quartus II software to control whether a clock input pin
drives either a global, regional, or dual-regional clock network. The
Quartus II software automatically selects the clocking resources if not
specified.
Clock Control Block
Each global clock, regional clock, and PLL external clock output has its
own clock control block. The control block has two functions:
Clock source selection (dynamic selection for global clocks)
Clock power-down (dynamic clock enable/disable)
IO_CLKJ[7:0] IO_CLKI[7:0]
IO_CLKA[7:0] IO_CLKB[7:0]
8
24 Clocks in the
Quadrant
24 Clocks in the
Quadrant
24 Clocks in the
Quadrant
24 Clocks in the
Quadrant
8 8 8
I/O Clock Regions
IO_CLKL[7:0] IO_CLKK[7:0]
IO_CLKC[7:0] IO_CLKD[7:0]
8888
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
IO_CLKE[7:0]
IO_CLKF[7:0]
IO_CLKG[7:0]
IO_CLKH[7:0]
IO_CLKN[7:0]
IO_CLKM[7:0]
IO_CLKP[7:0]
IO_CLKO[7:0]
2–54 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
1When using the global or regional clock control blocks in
Stratix II devices to select between multiple clocks or to enable
and disable clock networks, be aware of possible narrow pulses
or glitches when switching from one clock signal to another. A
glitch or runt pulse has a width that is less than the width of the
highest frequency input clock signal. To prevent logic errors
within the FPGA, Altera recommends that you build circuits
that filter out glitches and runt pulses.
Figures 2–37 through 2–39 show the clock control block for the global
clock, regional clock, and PLL external clock output, respectively.
Figure 2–37. Global Clock Control Blocks
Notes to Figure 2–37:
(1) These clock select signals can be dynamically controlled through internal logic
when the device is operating in user mode.
(2) These clock select signals can only be set through a configuration file (.sof or .pof)
and cannot be dynamically controlled during user mode operation.
CLKp
Pins
PLL Counter
Outputs
Internal
Logic
CLKn
Pin
Enable/
Disable
GCLK
Internal
Logic
Static Clock Select
This multiplexer supports
User-Controllable
Dynamic Switching
CLKSELECT[1..0]
(1)
(2)
2
22
Altera Corporation 2–55
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–38. Regional Clock Control Blocks
Notes to Figure 2–38:
(1) These clock select signals can only be set through a configuration file (.sof or .pof)
and cannot be dynamically controlled during user mode operation.
(2) Only the CLKn pins on the top and bottom of the device feed to regional clock select
blocks.The clock outputs from corner PLLs cannot be dynamically selected
through the global clock control block.
(3) The clock outputs from corner PLLs cannot be dynamically selected through the
global clock control block.
CLKp
Pin
PLL Counter
Outputs Internal
Logic
CLKn
Pin
Enable/
Disable
RCLK
Internal
Logic
Static Clock Select (1
)
2
(2)
(3)
2–56 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
Figure 2–39. External PLL Output Clock Control Blocks
Notes to Figure 2–39:
(1) These clock select signals can only be set through a configuration file (.sof or .pof)
and cannot be dynamically controlled during user mode operation.
(2) The clock control block feeds to a multiplexer within the PLL_OUT pin’s IOE. The
PLL_OUT pin is a dual-purpose pin. Therefore, this multiplexer selects either an
internal signal or the output of the clock control block.
For the global clock control block, the clock source selection can be
controlled either statically or dynamically. The user has the option of
statically selecting the clock source by using the Quartus II software to set
specific configuration bits in the configuration file (.sof or .pof) or the
user can control the selection dynamically by using internal logic to drive
the multiplexor select inputs. When selecting statically, the clock source
can be set to any of the inputs to the select multiplexor. When selecting
the clock source dynamically, you can either select between two PLL
outputs (such as the C0 or C1 outputs from one PLL), between two PLLs
(such as the C0/C1 clock output of one PLL or the C0/C1 c1ock output of
the other PLL), between two clock pins (such as CLK0 or CLK1), or
between a combination of clock pins or PLL outputs. The clock outputs
from corner PLLs cannot be dynamically selected through the global
control block.
For the regional and PLL_OUT clock control block, the clock source
selection can only be controlled statically using configuration bits. Any of
the inputs to the clock select multiplexor can be set as the clock source.
PLL Counter
Outputs (c[5..0])
Enable/
Disable
PLL_OUT
Pin
Internal
Logic
Static Clock Select
IOE
(1)
Static Clock
Select (1)
6
Internal
Logic
(2)
Altera Corporation 2–57
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The Stratix II clock networks can be disabled (powered down) by both
static and dynamic approaches. When a clock net is powered down, all
the logic fed by the clock net is in an off-state thereby reducing the overall
power consumption of the device.
The global and regional clock networks can be powered down statically
through a setting in the configuration (.sof or .pof) file. Clock networks
that are not used are automatically powered down through configuration
bit settings in the configuration file generated by the Quartus II software.
The dynamic clock enable/disable feature allows the internal logic to
control power up/down synchronously on GCLK and RCLK nets and
PLL_OUT pins. This function is independent of the PLL and is applied
directly on the clock network or PLL_OUT pin, as shown in Figures 2–37
through 2–39.
1The following restrictions for the input clock pins apply:
CLK0 pin -> inclk[0] of CLKCTRL
CLK1 pin -> inclk[1] of CLKCTRL
CLK2 pin -> inclk[0] of CLKCTRL
CLK3 pin -> inclk[1] of CLKCTRL
In general, even CLK numbers connect to the inclk[0] port of
CLKCTRL, and odd CLK numbers connect to the inclk[1] port
of CLKCTRL.
Failure to comply with these restrictions will result in a no-fit
error.
Enhanced & Fast PLLs
Stratix II devices provide robust clock management and synthesis using
up to four enhanced PLLs and eight fast PLLs. These PLLs increase
performance and provide advanced clock interfacing and clock-
frequency synthesis. With features such as clock switchover,
spread-spectrum clocking, reconfigurable bandwidth, phase control, and
reconfigurable phase shifting, the Stratix II device’s enhanced PLLs
provide you with complete control of clocks and system timing. The fast
PLLs provide general purpose clocking with multiplication and phase
shifting as well as high-speed outputs for high-speed differential I/O
support. Enhanced and fast PLLs work together with the Stratix II
high-speed I/O and advanced clock architecture to provide significant
improvements in system performance and bandwidth.
2–58 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
The Quartus II software enables the PLLs and their features without
requiring any external devices. Table 2–9 shows the PLLs available for
each Stratix II device and their type.
Table 2–9. Stratix II Device PLL Availability
Device Fast PLLs Enhanced PLLs
123478910561112
EP2S15 vvvv vv
EP2S30 vvvv vv
EP2S60 (1) vvvvvvvvvvvv
EP2S90 (2) vvvvvvvvvvvv
EP2S130 (3) vvvvvvvvvvvv
EP2S180 vvvvvvvvvvvv
Notes to Tab l e 2 9 :
(1) EP2S60 devices in the 1020-pin package contain 12 PLLs. EP2S60 devices in the 484-pin and 672-pin packages
contain fast PLLs 1–4 and enhanced PLLs 5 and 6.
(2) EP2S90 devices in the 1020-pin and 1508-pin packages contain 12 PLLs. EP2S90 devices in the 484-pin and 780-pin
packages contain fast PLLS 1–4 and enhanced PLLs 5 and 6.
(3) EP2S130 devices in the 1020-pin and 1508-pin packages contain 12PLLs. The EP2S130 device in the 780-pin package
contains fast PLLs 1–4 and enhanced PLLs 5 and 6.
Altera Corporation 2–59
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Table 2–10 shows the enhanced PLL and fast PLL features in Stratix II
devices.
Table 2–10. Stratix II PLL Features
Feature Enhanced PLL Fast PLL
Clock multiplication and division m/(n × post-scale counter) (1) m/(n × post-scale counter) (2)
Phase shift Down to 125-ps increments (3), (4) Down to 125-ps increments (3), (4)
Clock switchover vv (5)
PLL reconfiguration vv
Reconfigurable bandwidth vv
Spread spectrum clocking v
Programmable duty cycle vv
Number of internal clock outputs 6 4
Number of external clock outputs Three differential/six single-ended (6)
Number of feedback clock inputs One single-ended or differential
(7), (8)
Notes to Table 2–10:
(1) For enhanced PLLs, m ranges from 1 to 256, while n and post-scale counters range from 1 to 512 with 50% duty
cycle.
(2) For fast PLLs, m, and post-scale counters range from 1 to 32. The n counter ranges from 1 to 4.
(3) The smallest phase shift is determined by the voltage controlled oscillator (VCO) period divided by 8.
(4) For degree increments, Stratix II devices can shift all output frequencies in increments of at least 45. Smaller degree
increments are possible depending on the frequency and divide parameters.
(5) Stratix II fast PLLs only support manual clock switchover.
(6) Fast PLLs can drive to any I/O pin as an external clock. For high-speed differential I/O pins, the device uses a data
channel to generate txclkout.
(7) If the feedback input is used, you lose one (or two, if FBIN is differential) external clock output pin.
(8) Every Stratix II device has at least two enhanced PLLs with one single-ended or differential external feedback input
per PLL.
2–60 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
Figure 2–40 shows a top-level diagram of the Stratix II device and PLL
floorplan.
Figure 2–40. PLL Locations
Figures 2–41 and 2–42 shows the global and regional clocking from the
fast PLL outputs and the side clock pins.
FPLL7CLK FPLL10CLK
FPLL9CLK
CLK[8..11]
FPLL8CLK
CLK[3..0]
7
1
2
8
10
4
3
9
511
612
CLK[7..4]
CLK[15..12]
PLLs
Altera Corporation 2–61
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–41. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Center Clock Pins &
Fast PLL Outputs Note (1)
Notes to Figure 2–41:
(1) EP2S15 and EP2S30 devices only have four fast PLLs (1, 2, 3, and 4), but the
connectivity from these four PLLs to the global and regional clock networks
remains the same as shown.
(2) The global or regional clocks in a fast PLL's quadrant can drive the fast PLL input.
The global or regional clock input can be driven by an output from another PLL, a
pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock, or through a clock control block,
provided the clock control block is fed by an output from another PLL or a
pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock. An internally generated global
signal cannot drive the PLL.
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 1
RCK0 RCK2
RCK1 RCK3
GCK0 GCK2 GCK9 GCK11
GCK1 GCK3 GCK8 GCK10
RCK4 RCK6
RCK5 RCK7
RCK17
RCK16 RCK18
RCK19 RCK21 RCK23
RCK20 RCK22
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 2
Logic Array
Signal Input
To Clock
Network
CLK0
CLK1
CLK2
CLK3
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 4
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 3
CLK11
CLK10
CLK9
CLK8
2–62 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
Figure 2–42. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Corner Clock Pins &
Fast PLL Outputs Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–42:
(1) The corner fast PLLs can also be driven through the global or regional clock
networks. The global or regional clock input can be driven by an output from
another PLL, a pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock, or through a clock
control block, provided the clock control block is fed by an output from another
PLL or a pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock. An internally generated
global signal cannot drive the PLL.
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 7
RCK0 RCK2
RCK1 RCK3
GCK0 GCK2 GCK9 GCK11
GCK1 GCK3 GCK8 GCK10
RCK4 RCK6
RCK5 RCK7
RCK17
RCK16 RCK18
RCK19
RCK21 RCK23
RCK20 RCK22
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 8
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 10
C0
C1
C2
C3
Fast
PLL 9
FPLL7CLK
FPLL8CLK
FPLL10CL
K
FPLL9CL
K
Altera Corporation 2–63
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–43 shows the global and regional clocking from enhanced PLL
outputs and top and bottom CLK pins. The connections to the global and
regional clocks from the top clock pins and enhanced PLL outputs is
shown in Table 2–11. The connections to the clocks from the bottom clock
pins is shown in Table 2–12.
2–64 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
Figure 2–43. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Top & Bottom Clock Pins & Enhanced PLL Outputs
Notes (1), (2), and (3)
Notes to Figure 2–43:
(1) EP2S15 and EP2S30 devices only have two enhanced PLLs (5 and 6), but the connectivity from these two PLLs to
the global and regional clock networks remains the same as shown.
(2) If the design uses the feedback input, you lose one (or two, if FBIN is differential) external clock output pin.
(3) The enhanced PLLs can also be driven through the global or regional clock netowrks. The global or regional clock
input can be driven by an output from another PLL, a pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock, or through a
clock control block provided the clock control block is fed by an output from another PLL or a pin-driven dedicated
global or regional clock. An internally generated global signal cannot drive the PLL.
G15
G14
G13
G12
RCLK31
RCLK30
RCLK29
RCLK28
RCLK27
RCLK26
RCLK25
RCLK24
G7
G6
G5
G4
RCLK15
RCLK14
RCLK13
RCLK12
RCLK11
RCLK10
RCLK9
RCLK8
PLL 6
CLK7
CLK6
CLK5
CLK4
PLL 12
PLL 5
c0 c1 c2 c3 c4 c5 c0 c1 c2 c3 c4 c5
c0 c1 c2 c3 c4 c5 c0 c1 c2 c3 c4 c5
CLK14
CLK15
CLK13
CLK12
PLL 11
PLL11_FB
PLL5_OUT[2..0]p
PLL5_OUT[2..0]n
PLL11_OUT[2..0]p
PLL11_OUT[2..0]n
PLL12_OUT[2..0]p
PLL12_OUT[2..0]n PLL6_OUT[2..0]p
PLL6_OUT[2..0]n
PLL5_FB
PLL12_FB PLL6_FB
Global
Clocks
Regional
Clocks
Regional
Clocks
Altera Corporation 2–65
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Table 2–11. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Top Clock Pins & Enhanced PLL Outputs (Part 1
of 2)
Top Side Global & Regional
Clock Network Connectivity
DLLCLK
CLK12
CLK13
CLK14
CLK15
RCLK24
RCLK25
RCLK26
RCLK27
RCLK28
RCLK29
RCLK30
RCLK31
Clock pins
CLK12p vvv v v
CLK13p vvv v v
CLK14p vvvv v
CLK15p vvv vv
CLK12n vvv
CLK13n vv v
CLK14n vvv
CLK15n vvv
Drivers from internal logic
GCLKDRV0 v
GCLKDRV1 v
GCLKDRV2 v
GCLKDRV3 v
RCLKDRV0 vv
RCLKDRV1 vv
RCLKDRV2 vv
RCLKDRV3 vv
RCLKDRV4 vv
RCLKDRV5 vv
RCLKDRV6 vv
RCLKDRV7 vv
Enhanced PLL 5 outputs
c0 vvv v v
c1 vvv v v
c2 vvvv v
c3 vvvvv
2–66 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
c4 vvvvv
c5 v vvvv
Enhanced PLL 11 outputs
c0 vv v v
c1 vv v v
c2 vv v v
c3 vvvv
c4 vvvv
c5 vvvv
Table 2–11. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Top Clock Pins & Enhanced PLL Outputs (Part 2
of 2)
Top Side Global & Regional
Clock Network Connectivity
DLLCLK
CLK12
CLK13
CLK14
CLK15
RCLK24
RCLK25
RCLK26
RCLK27
RCLK28
RCLK29
RCLK30
RCLK31
Table 2–12. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Bottom Clock Pins & Enhanced PLL
Outputs (Part 1 of 2)
Bottom Side Global &
Regional Clock Network
Connectivity
DLLCLK
CLK4
CLK5
CLK6
CLK7
RCLK8
RCLK9
RCLK10
RCLK11
RCLK12
RCLK13
RCLK14
RCLK15
Clock pins
CLK4p vvv v v
CLK5p vvv v v
CLK6p vvvv v
CLK7p vvvvv
CLK4n vvv
CLK5n vvv
CLK6n vvv
CLK7n vvv
Drivers from internal logic
GCLKDRV0 v
GCLKDRV1 v
GCLKDRV2 v
Altera Corporation 2–67
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
GCLKDRV3 v
RCLKDRV0 vv
RCLKDRV1 vv
RCLKDRV2 vv
RCLKDRV3 vv
RCLKDRV4 vv
RCLKDRV5 vv
RCLKDRV6 vv
RCLKDRV7 vv
Enhanced PLL 6 outputs
c0 vvv v v
c1 vvv v v
c2 vvvv v
c3 vvvvv
c4 vvvvv
c5 v vvvv
Enhanced PLL 12 outputs
c0 vv v v
c1 vv v v
c2 vv v v
c3 vvvv
c4 vvvv
c5 vvvv
Table 2–12. Global & Regional Clock Connections from Bottom Clock Pins & Enhanced PLL
Outputs (Part 2 of 2)
Bottom Side Global &
Regional Clock Network
Connectivity
DLLCLK
CLK4
CLK5
CLK6
CLK7
RCLK8
RCLK9
RCLK10
RCLK11
RCLK12
RCLK13
RCLK14
RCLK15
2–68 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
PLLs & Clock Networks
Enhanced PLLs
Stratix II devices contain up to four enhanced PLLs with advanced clock
management features. Figure 2–44 shows a diagram of the enhanced PLL.
Figure 2–44. Stratix II Enhanced PLL Note (1)
Notes to Figure 2–44:
(1) Each clock source can come from any of the four clock pins that are physically located on the same side of the device
as the PLL.
(2) If the feedback input is used, you lose one (or two, if FBIN is differential) external clock output pin.
(3) Each enhanced PLL has three differential external clock outputs or six single-ended external clock outputs.
(4) The global or regional clock input can be driven by an output from another PLL, a pin-driven dedicated global or
regional clock, or through a clock control block, provided the clock control block is fed by an output from another
PLL or a pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock. An internally generated global signal cannot drive the PLL.
/n Charge
Pump VCO /c2
/c3
/c4
/c0
8
4
6
4Global
Clocks
/c1
Lock Detect to I/O or general
routing
INCLK[3..0]
FBIN
Global or
Regional
Clock
PFD
/c5
From Adjacent PLL
/m
Spread
Spectrum
I/O Buffers (3)
(2)
Loop
Filter
& Filter
Post-Scale
Counters
Clock
Switchover
Circuitry Phase Frequency
Detector
VCO Phase Selection
Selectable at Each
PLL Output Port
VCO Phase Selection
Affecting All Outputs
Shaded Portions of the
PLL are Reconfigurable
Regional
Clocks
8
6
(4)
Altera Corporation 2–69
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Fast PLLs
Stratix II devices contain up to eight fast PLLs with high-speed serial
interfacing ability. Figure 2–45 shows a diagram of the fast PLL.
Figure 2–45. Stratix II Device Fast PLL Notes (1), (2), (3)
Notes to Figure 2–45:
(1) The global or regional clock input can be driven by an output from another PLL, a pin-driven dedicated global or
regional clock, or through a clock control block, provided the clock control block is fed by an output from another
PLL or a pin-driven dedicated global or regional clock. An internally generated global signal cannot drive the PLL.
(2) In high-speed differential I/O support mode, this high-speed PLL clock feeds the SERDES circuitry. Stratix II
devices only support one rate of data transfer per fast PLL in high-speed differential I/O support mode.
(3) This signal is a differential I/O SERDES control signal.
(4) Stratix II fast PLLs only support manual clock switchover.
(5) If the design enables this ÷2 counter, then the device can use a VCO frequency range of 150 to 520 MHz.
fSee the PLLs in Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter in volume 2 of
the Stratix II Device Handbook or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook for
more information on enhanced and fast PLLs. See “High-Speed
Differential I/O with DPA Support” on page 2–96 for more information
on high-speed differential I/O support.
I/O Structure The Stratix II IOEs provide many features, including:
Dedicated differential and single-ended I/O buffers
3.3-V, 64-bit, 66-MHz PCI compliance
3.3-V, 64-bit, 133-MHz PCI-X 1.0 compliance
Joint Test Action Group (JTAG) boundary-scan test (BST) support
On-chip driver series termination
On-chip parallel termination
On-chip termination for differential standards
Programmable pull-up during configuration
Charge
Pump VCO ÷c1
8
8
4
4
8
Clock
Input
PFD
÷c0
÷m
Loop
Filter
Phase
Frequency
Detector
VCO Phase Selection
Selectable at each PLL
Output Port
Post-Scale
Counters
Global clocks
diffioclk1
load_en1
load_en0
diffioclk0
Regional clocks
to DPA block
Global or
regional clock
(1)
Global or
regional clock
(1)
÷c2
÷k
÷c3
÷n
4
Clock
Switchover
Circuitry
(4)
Shaded Portions of the
PLL are Reconfigurable
(2)
(2)
(3)
(3)
(5)
2–70 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Output drive strength control
Tri-state buffers
Bus-hold circuitry
Programmable pull-up resistors
Programmable input and output delays
Open-drain outputs
DQ and DQS I/O pins
Double data rate (DDR) registers
The IOE in Stratix II devices contains a bidirectional I/O buffer, six
registers, and a latch for a complete embedded bidirectional single data
rate or DDR transfer. Figure 2–46 shows the Stratix II IOE structure. The
IOE contains two input registers (plus a latch), two output registers, and
two output enable registers. The design can use both input registers and
the latch to capture DDR input and both output registers to drive DDR
outputs. Additionally, the design can use the output enable (OE) register
for fast clock-to-output enable timing. The negative edge-clocked OE
register is used for DDR SDRAM interfacing. The Quartus II software
automatically duplicates a single OE register that controls multiple
output or bidirectional pins.
Altera Corporation 2–71
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–46. Stratix II IOE Structure
The IOEs are located in I/O blocks around the periphery of the Stratix II
device. There are up to four IOEs per row I/O block and four IOEs per
column I/O block. The row I/O blocks drive row, column, or direct link
interconnects. The column I/O blocks drive column interconnects.
Figure 2–47 shows how a row I/O block connects to the logic array.
Figure 2–48 shows how a column I/O block connects to the logic array.
DQ
Output Register
Output A
DQ
Output Register
Output B
Input A
Input B
DQ
OE Register
OE
DQ
OE Register
DQ
Input Register
DQ
Input Register
DQ
Input Latch
Logic Array
CLK
ENA
2–72 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Figure 2–47. Row I/O Block Connection to the Interconnect Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–47:
(1) The 32 data and control signals consist of eight data out lines: four lines each for DDR applications
io_dataouta[3..0] and io_dataoutb[3..0], four output enables io_oe[3..0], four input clock enables
io_ce_in[3..0], four output clock enables io_ce_out[3..0], four clocks io_clk[3..0], four asynchronous
clear and preset signals io_aclr/apreset[3..0], and four synchronous clear and preset signals
io_sclr/spreset[3..0].
32
R4 & R24
Interconnects C4 Interconnect
I/O Block Local
Interconnect
32 Data & Control
Signals from
Logic Array (1)
io_dataina[3..0]
io_datainb[3..0]
io_clk[7:0]
Horizontal I/O
Block Contains
up to Four IOEs
Direct Link
Interconnect
to Adjacent LAB
Direct Link
Interconnect
to Adjacent LAB
LAB Local
Interconnect
LAB Horizontal
I/O Block
Altera Corporation 2–73
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–48. Column I/O Block Connection to the Interconnect Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–48:
(1) The 32 data and control signals consist of eight data out lines: four lines each for DDR applications
io_dataouta[3..0] and io_dataoutb[3..0], four output enables io_oe[3..0], four input clock enables
io_ce_in[3..0], four output clock enables io_ce_out[3..0], four clocks io_clk[3..0], four asynchronous
clear and preset signals io_aclr/apreset[3..0], and four synchronous clear and preset signals
io_sclr/spreset[3..0].
32 Data &
Control Signals
from Logic Array (1) Vertical I/O
Block Contains
up to Four IOEs
I/O Block
Local Interconnect
IO_dataina[3:0]
IO_datainb[3:0]
R4 & R24
Interconnects
LAB Local
Interconnect
C4 & C16
Interconnects
32
LAB LAB LAB
io_clk[7..0]
Vertical I/O Block
2–74 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
There are 32 control and data signals that feed each row or column I/O
block. These control and data signals are driven from the logic array. The
row or column IOE clocks, io_clk[7..0], provide a dedicated routing
resource for low-skew, high-speed clocks. I/O clocks are generated from
global or regional clocks (see the “PLLs & Clock Networks” section).
Figure 2–49 illustrates the signal paths through the I/O block.
Figure 2–49. Signal Path through the I/O Block
Each IOE contains its own control signal selection for the following
control signals: oe, ce_in, ce_out, aclr/apreset, sclr/spreset,
clk_in, and clk_out. Figure 2–50 illustrates the control signal
selection.
Row or Column
io_clk[7..0]
io_dataina
io_datainb
io_dataouta
io_dataoutb
io_oe
oe
ce_in
ce_out
io_ce_in
aclr/apreset
io_ce_out
sclr/spreset
io_sclr
io_aclr
clk_in
io_clk
clk_out
Control
Signal
Selection
IOE
To Logic
Array
From Logic
Array
To Other
IOEs
Altera Corporation 2–75
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–50. Control Signal Selection per IOE
Notes to Figure 2–50:
(1) Control signals ce_in, ce_out, aclr/apreset, sclr/spreset, and oe can be global signals even though their
control selection multiplexers are not directly fed by the ioe_clk[7..0] signals. The ioe_clk signals can drive
the I/O local interconnect, which then drives the control selection multiplexers.
In normal bidirectional operation, the input register can be used for input
data requiring fast setup times. The input register can have its own clock
input and clock enable separate from the OE and output registers. The
output register can be used for data requiring fast clock-to-output
performance. The OE register can be used for fast clock-to-output enable
timing. The OE and output register share the same clock source and the
same clock enable source from local interconnect in the associated LAB,
dedicated I/O clocks, and the column and row interconnects.
clk_out
ce_inclk_in
ce_out
aclr/apreset
sclr/spreset
Dedicated I/O
Clock [7..0]
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
Local
Interconnect
oe
io_oe
io_aclr
Local
Interconnect
io_sclr
io_ce_out
io_ce_in
io_clk
2–76 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Figure 2–51 shows the IOE in bidirectional configuration.
Figure 2–51. Stratix II IOE in Bidirectional I/O Configuration Note (1)
Notes to Figure 2–51:
(1) All input signals to the IOE can be inverted at the IOE.
(2) The optional PCI clamp is only available on column I/O pins.
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Chip-Wide Reset
OE Register
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Output Register
VCCIO
VCCIO
PCI Clamp (2)
Programmable
Pull-Up
Resistor
Column, Row,
or Local
Interconnect
ioe_clk[7..0]
Bus-Hold
Circuit
OE Register
tCO Delay
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Input Register
Input Pin to
Input Register Delay
Input Pin to
Logic Array Delay
Drive Strength Control
Open-Drain Output
On-Chip
Termination
sclr/spreset
oe
clkout
ce_out
aclr/apreset
clkin
ce_in
Output
Pin Delay
Altera Corporation 2–77
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The Stratix II device IOE includes programmable delays that can be
activated to ensure input IOE register-to-logic array register transfers,
input pin-to-logic array register transfers, or output IOE register-to-pin
transfers.
A path in which a pin directly drives a register may require the delay to
ensure zero hold time, whereas a path in which a pin drives a register
through combinational logic may not require the delay. Programmable
delays exist for decreasing input-pin-to-logic-array and IOE input
register delays. The Quartus II Compiler can program these delays to
automatically minimize setup time while providing a zero hold time.
Programmable delays can increase the register-to-pin delays for output
and/or output enable registers. Programmable delays are no longer
required to ensure zero hold times for logic array register-to-IOE register
transfers. The Quartus II Compiler can create the zero hold time for these
transfers. Table 2–13 shows the programmable delays for Stratix II
devices.
The IOE registers in Stratix II devices share the same source for clear or
preset. You can program preset or clear for each individual IOE. You can
also program the registers to power up high or low after configuration is
complete. If programmed to power up low, an asynchronous clear can
control the registers. If programmed to power up high, an asynchronous
preset can control the registers. This feature prevents the inadvertent
activation of another device's active-low input upon power-up. If one
register in an IOE uses a preset or clear signal then all registers in the IOE
must use that same signal if they require preset or clear. Additionally, a
synchronous reset signal is available for the IOE registers.
Double Data Rate I/O Pins
Stratix II devices have six registers in the IOE, which support DDR
interfacing by clocking data on both positive and negative clock edges.
The IOEs in Stratix II devices support DDR inputs, DDR outputs, and
bidirectional DDR modes.
Table 2–13. Stratix II Programmable Delay Chain
Programmable Delays Quartus II Logic Option
Input pin to logic array delay Input delay from pin to internal cells
Input pin to input register delay Input delay from pin to input register
Output pin delay Delay from output register to output pin
Output enable register tCO delay Delay to output enable pin
2–78 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
When using the IOE for DDR inputs, the two input registers clock double
rate input data on alternating edges. An input latch is also used in the IOE
for DDR input acquisition. The latch holds the data that is present during
the clock high times. This allows both bits of data to be synchronous with
the same clock edge (either rising or falling). Figure 2–52 shows an IOE
configured for DDR input. Figure 2–53 shows the DDR input timing
diagram.
Figure 2–52. Stratix II IOE in DDR Input I/O Configuration Notes (1), (2), (3)
Notes to Figure 2–52:
(1) All input signals to the IOE can be inverted at the IOE.
(2) This signal connection is only allowed on dedicated DQ function pins.
(3) This signal is for dedicated DQS function pins only.
(4) The optional PCI clamp is only available on column I/O pins.
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Chip-Wide Reset
Input Register
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Input Register
VCCIO
VCCIO
PCI Clamp (4)
Programmable
Pull-Up
Resistor
Column, Row,
or Local
Interconnect DQS Local
Bus
(2)
To DQS Logic
Block
(3)
ioe_clk[7..0]
Bus-Hold
Circuit
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Latch
I
nput Pin to
Input RegisterDelay
sclr/spreset
clkin
aclr/apreset
On-Chip
Termination
ce_in
Altera Corporation 2–79
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–53. Input Timing Diagram in DDR Mode
When using the IOE for DDR outputs, the two output registers are
configured to clock two data paths from ALMs on rising clock edges.
These output registers are multiplexed by the clock to drive the output
pin at a ×2 rate. One output register clocks the first bit out on the clock
high time, while the other output register clocks the second bit out on the
clock low time. Figure 2–54 shows the IOE configured for DDR output.
Figure 2–55 shows the DDR output timing diagram.
Data at
input pin
CLK
A0B0 B1 A1
A1
B2 A2 A3
A2 A3
B1
A0
B0 B2 B3
B3 B4
Input To
Logic Array
2–80 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Figure 2–54. Stratix II IOE in DDR Output I/O Configuration Notes (1), (2)
Notes to Figure 2–54:
(1) All input signals to the IOE can be inverted at the IOE.
(2) The tri-state buffer is active low. The DDIO megafunction represents the tri-state buffer as active-high with an
inverter at the OE register data port. Similarly, the aclr and apreset signals are also active-high at the input ports
of the DDIO megafunction.
(3) The optional PCI clamp is only available on column I/O pins.
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Chip-Wide Reset
OE Register
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
OE Register
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Output Register
VCCIO
VCCIO
PCI Clamp (3)
Programmable
Pull-Up
Resistor
Column, Row,
or Local
Interconnect
ioe_clk[7..0]
Bus-Hold
Circuit
OE Register
tCO Delay
CLRN/PRN
DQ
ENA
Output Register
Drive Strength
Control
Open-Drain Output
Used for
DDR, DDR2
SDRAM
sclr/spreset
aclr/apreset
clkout
Output
Pin Delay
On-Chip
Termination
oe
ce_out
clk
Altera Corporation 2–81
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–55. Output TIming Diagram in DDR Mode
The Stratix II IOE operates in bidirectional DDR mode by combining the
DDR input and DDR output configurations. The negative-edge-clocked
OE register holds the OE signal inactive until the falling edge of the clock.
This is done to meet DDR SDRAM timing requirements.
External RAM Interfacing
In addition to the six I/O registers in each IOE, Stratix II devices also have
dedicated phase-shift circuitry for interfacing with external memory
interfaces. Stratix II devices support DDR and DDR2 SDRAM, QDR II
SRAM, RLDRAM II, and SDR SDRAM memory interfaces. In every
Stratix II device, the I/O banks at the top (banks 3 and 4) and bottom
(banks 7 and 8) of the device support DQ and DQS signals with DQ bus
modes of ×4, ×8/×9, ×16/×18, or ×32/×36. Table 2–14 shows the number
of DQ and DQS buses that are supported per device.
From Internal
Registers
DDR output
CLK
B1 A1 B2 A2 B3 A3 B4 A4
A2A1 A3 A4
B1 B2 B3 B4
Table 2–14. DQS & DQ Bus Mode Support (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Device Package Number of
×4 Groups
Number of
×8/×9 Groups
Number of
×16/×18 Groups
Number of
×32/×36 Groups
EP2S15 484-pin FineLine BGA 8 4 0 0
672-pin FineLine BGA 18 8 4 0
EP2S30 484-pin FineLine BGA 8 4 0 0
672-pin FineLine BGA 18 8 4 0
EP2S60 484-pin FineLine BGA 8 4 0 0
672-pin FineLine BGA 18 8 4 0
1,020-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
2–82 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
A compensated delay element on each DQS pin automatically aligns
input DQS synchronization signals with the data window of their
corresponding DQ data signals. The DQS signals drive a local DQS bus in
the top and bottom I/O banks. This DQS bus is an additional resource to
the I/O clocks and is used to clock DQ input registers with the DQS
signal.
The Stratix II device has two phase-shifting reference circuits, one on the
top and one on the bottom of the device. The circuit on the top controls
the compensated delay elements for all DQS pins on the top. The circuit
on the bottom controls the compensated delay elements for all DQS pins
on the bottom.
Each phase-shifting reference circuit is driven by a system reference clock,
which must have the same frequency as the DQS signal. Clock pins
CLK[15..12]p feed the phase circuitry on the top of the device and
clock pins CLK[7..4]p feed the phase circuitry on the bottom of the
device. In addition, PLL clock outputs can also feed the phase-shifting
reference circuits.
Figure 2–56 illustrates the phase-shift reference circuit control of each
DQS delay shift on the top of the device. This same circuit is duplicated
on the bottom of the device.
EP2S90 484-pin Hybrid FineLine BGA 8 4 0 0
780-pin FineLine BGA 18 8 4 0
1,020-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
1,508-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
EP2S130 780-pin FineLine BGA 18 8 4 0
1,020-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
1,508-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
EP2S180 1,020-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
1,508-pin FineLine BGA 36 18 8 4
Notes to Table 2–14:
(1) Check the pin table for each DQS/DQ group in the different modes.
Table 2–14. DQS & DQ Bus Mode Support (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Device Package Number of
×4 Groups
Number of
×8/×9 Groups
Number of
×16/×18 Groups
Number of
×32/×36 Groups
Altera Corporation 2–83
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–56. DQS Phase-Shift Circuitry Notes (1), (2), (3), (4)
Notes to Figure 2–56:
(1) There are up to 18 pairs of DQS and DQSn pins available on the top or the bottom of the Stratix II device. There are
up to 10 pairs on the right side and 8 pairs on the left side of the DQS phase-shift circuitry.
(2) The Δt module represents the DQS logic block.
(3) Clock pins CLK[15..12]p feed the phase-shift circuitry on the top of the device and clock pins CLK[7..4]p feed
the phase circuitry on the bottom of the device. You can also use a PLL clock output as a reference clock to the phase-
shift circuitry.
(4) You can only use PLL 5 to feed the DQS phase-shift circuitry on the top of the device and PLL 6 to feed the DQS
phase-shift circuitry on the bottom of the device.
These dedicated circuits combined with enhanced PLL clocking and
phase-shift ability provide a complete hardware solution for interfacing
to high-speed memory.
fFor more information on external memory interfaces, refer to the
External Memory Interfaces in Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter in
volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the Stratix II GX Device
Handbook.
Programmable Drive Strength
The output buffer for each Stratix II device I/O pin has a programmable
drive strength control for certain I/O standards. The LVTTL, LVCMOS,
SSTL, and HSTL standards have several levels of drive strength that the
user can control. The default setting used in the Quartus II software is the
maximum current strength setting that is used to achieve maximum I/O
performance. For all I/O standards, the minimum setting is the lowest
drive strength that guarantees the IOH/IOL of the standard. Using
minimum settings provides signal slew rate control to reduce system
noise and signal overshoot.
DQS
Pin
DQSn
Pin
DQSn
Pin
DQS
Pin
DQS
Pin
DQSn
Pin
DQS
Pin
DQSn
Pin
From PLL 5
(3)
CLK[15..12]p
(2)
to IOE to IOE to IOE to IOE
to IOE to IOE
to IOE
ΔtΔtΔtΔtΔtΔtΔt
to IOE
DQS
Phase-Shift
Circuitry
Δt
DQS Logic
Blocks
2–84 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Table 2–15 shows the possible settings for the I/O standards with drive
strength control.
Open-Drain Output
Stratix II devices provide an optional open-drain (equivalent to an open-
collector) output for each I/O pin. This open-drain output enables the
device to provide system-level control signals (e.g., interrupt and write-
enable signals) that can be asserted by any of several devices.
Bus Hold
Each Stratix II device I/O pin provides an optional bus-hold feature. The
bus-hold circuitry can weakly hold the signal on an I/O pin at its
last-driven state. Since the bus-hold feature holds the last-driven state of
the pin until the next input signal is present, you do not need an external
pull-up or pull-down resistor to hold a signal level when the bus is
tri-stated.
Table 2–15. Programmable Drive Strength Note (1)
I/O Standard
IOH / IOL Current Strength
Setting (mA) for Column
I/O Pins
IOH / IOL Current Strength
Setting (mA) for Row I/O
Pins
3.3-V LVTTL 24, 20, 16, 12, 8, 4 12, 8, 4
3.3-V LVCMOS 24, 20, 16, 12, 8, 4 8, 4
2.5-V LVTTL/LVCMOS 16, 12, 8, 4 12, 8, 4
1.8-V LVTTL/LVCMOS 12, 10, 8, 6, 4, 2 8, 6, 4, 2
1.5-V LVCMOS 8, 6, 4, 2 4, 2
SSTL-2 Class I 12, 8 12, 8
SSTL-2 Class II 24, 20, 16 16
SSTL-18 Class I 12, 10, 8, 6, 4 10, 8, 6, 4
SSTL-18 Class II 20, 18, 16, 8 -
HSTL-18 Class I 12, 10, 8, 6, 4 12, 10, 8, 6, 4
HSTL-18 Class II 20, 18, 16 -
HSTL-15 Class I 12, 10, 8, 6, 4 8, 6, 4
HSTL-15 Class II 20, 18, 16 -
Note to Table 2–15:
(1) The Quartus II software default current setting is the maximum setting for each
I/O standard.
Altera Corporation 2–85
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
The bus-hold circuitry also pulls undriven pins away from the input
threshold voltage where noise can cause unintended high-frequency
switching. You can select this feature individually for each I/O pin. The
bus-hold output drives no higher than VCCIO to prevent overdriving
signals. If the bus-hold feature is enabled, the programmable pull-up
option cannot be used. Disable the bus-hold feature when the I/O pin has
been configured for differential signals.
The bus-hold circuitry uses a resistor with a nominal resistance (RBH) of
approximately 7 kΩ to weakly pull the signal level to the last-driven state.
See the DC & Switching Characteristics chapter in the Stratix II Device
Handbook, Volume 1, for the specific sustaining current driven through this
resistor and overdrive current used to identify the next-driven input
level. This information is provided for each VCCIO voltage level.
The bus-hold circuitry is active only after configuration. When going into
user mode, the bus-hold circuit captures the value on the pin present at
the end of configuration.
Programmable Pull-Up Resistor
Each Stratix II device I/O pin provides an optional programmable
pull-up resistor during user mode. If you enable this feature for an I/O
pin, the pull-up resistor (typically 25 kΩ) weakly holds the output to the
VCCIO level of the output pin’s bank.
Programmable pull-up resistors are only supported on user I/O pins, and
are not supported on dedicated configuration pins, JTAG pins or
dedicated clock pins.
Advanced I/O Standard Support
Stratix II device IOEs support the following I/O standards:
3.3-V LVTTL/LVCMOS
2.5-V LVTTL/LVCMOS
1.8-V LVTTL/LVCMOS
1.5-V LVCMOS
3.3-V PCI
3.3-V PCI-X mode 1
LVDS
LVPECL (on input and output clocks only)
HyperTransport technology
Differential 1.5-V HSTL Class I and II
Differential 1.8-V HSTL Class I and II
Differential SSTL-18 Class I and II
Differential SSTL-2 Class I and II
2–86 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
1.5-V HSTL Class I and II
1.8-V HSTL Class I and II
1.2-V HSTL
SSTL-2 Class I and II
SSTL-18 Class I and II
Table 2–16 describes the I/O standards supported by Stratix II devices.
Table 2–16. Stratix II Supported I/O Standards (Part 1 of 2)
I/O Standard Type Input Reference
Voltage (VREF) (V)
Output Supply
Voltage (VCCIO) (V)
Board Termination
Voltage (VTT) (V)
LVTTL Single-ended - 3.3 -
LVCMOS Single-ended - 3.3 -
2.5 V Single-ended - 2.5 -
1.8 V Single-ended - 1.8 -
1.5-V LVCMOS Single-ended - 1.5 -
3.3-V PCI Single-ended - 3.3 -
3.3-V PCI-X mode 1 Single-ended - 3.3 -
LVDS Differential - 2.5 (3) -
LVPECL (1) Differential - 3.3 -
HyperTransport technology Differential - 2.5 -
Differential 1.5-V HSTL
Class I and II (2)
Differential 0.75 1.5 0.75
Differential 1.8-V HSTL
Class I and II (2)
Differential 0.90 1.8 0.90
Differential SSTL-18 Class
I and II (2)
Differential 0.90 1.8 0.90
Differential SSTL-2 Class I
and II (2)
Differential 1.25 2.5 1.25
1.2-V HSTL(4) Voltage-referenced 0.6 1.2 0.6
1.5-V HSTL Class I and II Voltage-referenced 0.75 1.5 0.75
1.8-V HSTL Class I and II Voltage-referenced 0.9 1.8 0.9
SSTL-18 Class I and II Voltage-referenced 0.90 1.8 0.90
Altera Corporation 2–87
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
fFor more information on I/O standards supported by Stratix II I/O
banks, refer to the Selectable I/O Standards in Stratix II & Stratix II GX
Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the
Stratix II GX Device Handbook.
Stratix II devices contain eight I/O banks and four enhanced PLL external
clock output banks, as shown in Figure 2–57. The four I/O banks on the
right and left of the device contain circuitry to support high-speed
differential I/O for LVDS and HyperTransport inputs and outputs. These
banks support all Stratix II I/O standards except PCI or PCI-X I/O pins,
and SSTL-18 Class II and HSTL outputs. The top and bottom I/O banks
support all single-ended I/O standards. Additionally, enhanced PLL
external clock output banks allow clock output capabilities such as
differential support for SSTL and HSTL.
SSTL-2 Class I and II Voltage-referenced 1.25 2.5 1.25
Notes to Table 2–16:
(1) This I/O standard is only available on input and output column clock pins.
(2) This I/O standard is only available on input clock pins and DQS pins in I/O banks 3, 4, 7, and 8, and output clock
pins in I/O banks 9,10, 11, and 12.
(3) VCCIO is 3.3 V when using this I/O standard in input and output column clock pins (in I/O banks 9, 10, 11, and 12).
The clock input pins supporting LVDS on banks 3, 4, 7, and 8 use VCCINT for LVDS input operations and have no
dependency on the VCCIO level of the bank.
(4) 1.2-V HSTL is only supported in I/O banks 4,7, and 8.
Table 2–16. Stratix II Supported I/O Standards (Part 2 of 2)
I/O Standard Type Input Reference
Voltage (VREF) (V)
Output Supply
Voltage (VCCIO) (V)
Board Termination
Voltage (VTT) (V)
2–88 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Figure 2–57. Stratix II I/O Banks Notes (1), (2), (3), (4)
Notes to Figure 2–57:
(1) Figure 2–57 is a top view of the silicon die that corresponds to a reverse view for flip-chip packages. It is a graphical
representation only.
(2) Depending on the size of the device, different device members have different numbers of VREF groups. Refer to the
pin list and the Quartus II software for exact locations.
(3) Banks 9 through 12 are enhanced PLL external clock output banks. These PLL banks utilize the adjacent VREF group
when voltage-referenced standards are implemented. For example, if an SSTL input is implemented in PLL bank
10, the voltage level at VREFB7 is the reference voltage level for the SSTL input.
(4) Horizontal I/O banks feature SERDES and DPA circuitry for high speed differential I/O standards. See the High
Speed Differential I/O Interfaces in Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter of the Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 2
or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook, Volume 2 for more information on differential I/O standards.
Bank 3 Bank 4
Bank 11 Bank 9
PLL11 PLL5
PLL7
PLL1
PLL2
PLL4
PLL3
PLL10
I/O banks 7, 8, 10 & 12 support all
single-ended I/O standards and
differential I/O standards except for
HyperTransport technology for
both input and output operations.
I/O banks 3, 4, 9 & 11 support all
single-ended I/O standards and
differential I/O standards except for
HyperTransport technology for
both input and output operations.
VREF0B3 VREF1B3 VREF2B3 VREF3B3 VREF4B3 VREF0B4 VREF1B4 VREF2B4 VREF3B4 VREF4B4
Bank 8 Bank 7
Bank 12 Bank 10
PLL12 PLL6
PLL8 PLL9
VREF4B8 VREF3B8 VREF2B8 VREF1B8 VREF0B8 VREF4B7 VREF3B7 VREF2B7 VREF1B7 VREF0B7
VR EF3B 2VREF2B2VREF1B2VREF0B2
Bank 2
VREF3B1VREF2B1VREF1B1VREF0B1
Bank 1
VR EF1B 5VREF2B5VREF3B5VREF4B5
Bank 5
VREF1B6VREF2B6VREF3B6VREF4B6
Bank 6
VREF4B2
VREF0B5
VREF4B1
VREF0B6
DQS4T DQS3T DQS2T DQS1T DQS0T
DQS4B DQS3B DQS2B DQS1B DQS0BDQS8B DQS7B DQS6B DQS5B
DQS8T DQS7T DQS6T DQS5T
This I/O bank supports LVDS
and LVPECL standards for input
clock operations. Differential
HSTL and differential SSTL
standards are supported for both
input and output operations.
This I/O bank supports LVDS
and LVPECL standards for input
clock operations. Differential
HSTL and differential SSTL
standards are supported for both
input and output operations.
This I/O bank supports LVDS
and LVPECL standards for input
clock operations. Differential
HSTL and differential SSTL
standards are supported for both
input and output operations.
This I/O bank supports LVDS
and LVPECL standards for input
clock operations. Differential
HSTL and differential SSTL
standards are supported for both
input and output operations.
I/O banks 1, 2, 5 & 6 support LVTTL, LVCMOS,
2.5-V, 1.8-V, 1.5-V, SSTL-2, SSTL-18 Class I,
HSTL-18 Class I, HSTL-15 Class I, LVDS, and
HyperTransport standards for input and output
operations. HSTL-18 Class II, HSTL-15-Class II,
SSTL-18 Class II standards are only supported
for input operations.
Altera Corporation 2–89
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Each I/O bank has its own VCCIO pins. A single device can support
1.5-, 1.8-, 2.5-, and 3.3-V interfaces; each bank can support a different
VCCIO level independently. Each bank also has dedicated VREF pins to
support the voltage-referenced standards (such as SSTL-2). The PLL
banks utilize the adjacent VREF group when voltage-referenced
standards are implemented. For example, if an SSTL input is
implemented in PLL bank 10, the voltage level at VREFB7 is the reference
voltage level for the SSTL input.
I/O pins that reside in PLL banks 9 through 12 are powered by the
VCC_PLL<5, 6, 11, or 12>_OUT pins, respectively. The EP2S60F484,
EP2S60F780, EP2S90H484, EP2S90F780, and EP2S130F780 devices do not
support PLLs 11 and 12. Therefore, any I/O pins that reside in bank 11 are
powered by the VCCIO3 pin, and any I/O pins that reside in bank 12 are
powered by the VCCIO8 pin.
Each I/O bank can support multiple standards with the same VCCIO for
input and output pins. Each bank can support one VREF voltage level. For
example, when VCCIO is 3.3 V, a bank can support LVTTL, LVCMOS, and
3.3-V PCI for inputs and outputs.
On-Chip Termination
Stratix II devices provide differential (for the LVDS or HyperTransport
technology I/O standard), series, and parallel on-chip termination to
reduce reflections and maintain signal integrity. On-chip termination
simplifies board design by minimizing the number of external
termination resistors required. Termination can be placed inside the
package, eliminating small stubs that can still lead to reflections.
Stratix II devices provide four types of termination:
Differential termination (RD)
Series termination (RS) without calibration
Series termination (RS) with calibration
Parallel termination (RT) with calibration
2–90 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Table 2–17 shows the Stratix II on-chip termination support per I/O bank.
Table 2–17. On-Chip Termination Support by I/O Banks (Part 1 of 2)
On-Chip Termination Support I/O Standard Support Top & Bottom Banks Left & Right Banks
Series termination without
calibration
3.3-V LVTTL vv
3.3-V LVCMOS vv
2.5-V LVTTL vv
2.5-V LVCMOS vv
1.8-V LVTTL vv
1.8-V LVCMOS vv
1.5-V LVTTL vv
1.5-V LVCMOS vv
SSTL-2 Class I and II vv
SSTL-18 Class I v v
SSTL-18 Class II v
1.8-V HSTL Class I vv
1.8-V HSTL Class II v
1.5-V HSTL Class I vv
1.2-V HSTL v
Altera Corporation 2–91
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Series termination with
calibration
3.3-V LVTTL v
3.3-V LVCMOS v
2.5-V LVTTL v
2.5-V LVCMOS v
1.8-V LVTTL v
1.8-V LVCMOS v
1.5-V LVTTL v
1.5-V LVCMOS v
SSTL-2 Class I and II v
SSTL-18 Class I and II v
1.8-V HSTL Class I v
1.8-V HSTL Class II v
1.5-V HSTL Class I v
1.2-V HSTL v
Parallel termination with
calibration
SSTL-2 Class I and II v
SSTL-18 Class I and II v
1.8-V HSTL Class I v
1.8-V HSTL Class II v
1.5-V HSTL Class I and II v
1.2-V HSTL v
Differential termination (1) LVD S v
HyperTransport technology v
Note to Table 2–17:
(1) Clock pins CLK1, CLK3, CLK9, CLK11, and pins FPLL[7..10]CLK do not support differential on-chip
termination. Clock pins CLK0, CLK2, CLK8, and CLK10 do support differential on-chip termination. Clock pins in
the top and bottom banks (CLK[4..7, 12..15]) do not support differential on-chip termination.
Table 2–17. On-Chip Termination Support by I/O Banks (Part 2 of 2)
On-Chip Termination Support I/O Standard Support Top & Bottom Banks Left & Right Banks
2–92 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Differential On-Chip Termination
Stratix II devices support internal differential termination with a nominal
resistance value of 100 Ω for LVDS or HyperTransport technology input
receiver buffers. LVPECL input signals (supported on clock pins only)
require an external termination resistor. Differential on-chip termination
is supported across the full range of supported differential data rates as
shown in the DC & Switching Characteristics chapter in volume 1 of the
Stratix II Device Handbook.
fFor more information on differential on-chip termination, refer to the
High-Speed Differential I/O Interfaces with DPA in Stratix II & Stratix II GX
Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the
Stratix II GX Device Handbook.
fFor more information on tolerance specifications for differential on-chip
termination, refer to the DC & Switching Characteristics chapter in
volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
On-Chip Series Termination Without Calibration
Stratix II devices support driver impedance matching to provide the I/O
driver with controlled output impedance that closely matches the
impedance of the transmission line. As a result, reflections can be
significantly reduced. Stratix II devices support on-chip series
termination for single-ended I/O standards with typical RS values of 25
and 50 Ω. Once matching impedance is selected, current drive strength is
no longer selectable. Table 2–17 shows the list of output standards that
support on-chip series termination without calibration.
On-Chip Series Termination with Calibration
Stratix II devices support on-chip series termination with calibration in
column I/O pins in top and bottom banks. There is one calibration circuit
for the top I/O banks and one circuit for the bottom I/O banks. Each
on-chip series termination calibration circuit compares the total
impedance of each I/O buffer to the external 25- or 50-Ω resistors
connected to the RUP and RDN pins, and dynamically enables or disables
the transistors until they match. Calibration occurs at the end of device
configuration. Once the calibration circuit finds the correct impedance, it
powers down and stops changing the characteristics of the drivers.
fFor more information on series on-chip termination supported by
Stratix II devices, refer to the Selectable I/O Standards in Stratix II &
Stratix II GX Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook
or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook.
Altera Corporation 2–93
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
fFor more information on tolerance specifications for on-chip termination
with calibration, refer to the DC & Switching Characteristics chapter in
volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
On-Chip Parallel Termination with Calibration
Stratix II devices support on-chip parallel termination with calibration for
column I/O pins only. There is one calibration circuit for the top I/O
banks and one circuit for the bottom I/O banks. Each on-chip parallel
termination calibration circuit compares the total impedance of each I/O
buffer to the external 50-Ω resistors connected to the RUP and RDN pins
and dynamically enables or disables the transistors until they match.
Calibration occurs at the end of device configuration. Once the calibration
circuit finds the correct impedance, it powers down and stops changing
the characteristics of the drivers.
1On-chip parallel termination with calibration is only supported
for input pins.
fFor more information on on-chip termination supported by Stratix II
devices, refer to the Selectable I/O Standards in Stratix II & Stratix II GX
Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the
Stratix II GX Device Handbook.
fFor more information on tolerance specifications for on-chip termination
with calibration, refer to the DC & Switching Characteristics chapter in
volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
MultiVolt I/O Interface
The Stratix II architecture supports the MultiVolt I/O interface feature
that allows Stratix II devices in all packages to interface with systems of
different supply voltages.
The Stratix II VCCINT pins must always be connected to a 1.2-V power
supply. With a 1.2-V VCCINT level, input pins are 1.5-, 1.8-, 2.5-, and 3.3-V
tolerant. The VCCIO pins can be connected to either a 1.5-, 1.8-, 2.5-, or
3.3-V power supply, depending on the output requirements. The output
levels are compatible with systems of the same voltage as the power
supply (for example, when VCCIO pins are connected to a 1.5-V power
supply, the output levels are compatible with 1.5-V systems).
The Stratix II VCCPD power pins must be connected to a 3.3-V power
supply. These power pins are used to supply the pre-driver power to the
output buffers, which increases the performance of the output pins. The
VCCPD pins also power configuration input pins and JTAG input pins.
2–94 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
I/O Structure
Table 2–18 summarizes Stratix II MultiVolt I/O support.
The TDO and nCEO pins are powered by VCCIO of the bank that they reside
in. TDO is in I/O bank 4 and nCEO is in I/O bank 7.
Ideally, the VCC supplies for the I/O buffers of any two connected pins are
at the same voltage level. This may not always be possible depending on
the VCCIO level of TDO and nCEO pins on master devices and the
configuration voltage level chosen by VCCSEL on slave devices. Master
and slave devices can be in any position in the chain. Master indicates that
it is driving out TDO or nCEO to a slave device.
For multi-device passive configuration schemes, the nCEO pin of the
master device drives the nCE pin of the slave device. The VCCSEL pin on
the slave device selects which input buffer is used for nCE. When VCCSEL
is logic high, it selects the 1.8-V/1.5-V buffer powered by VCCIO. When
VCCSEL is logic low it selects the 3.3-V/2.5-V input buffer powered by
VCCPD. The ideal case is to have the VCCIO of the nCEO bank in a master
device match the VCCSEL settings for the nCE input buffer of the slave
device it is connected to, but that may not be possible depending on the
application. Table 2–19 contains board design recommendations to
ensure that nCEO can successfully drive nCE for all power supply
combinations.
Table 2–18. Stratix II MultiVolt I/O Support Note (1)
VCCIO (V) Input Signal (V) Output Signal (V)
1.2 1.5 1.8 2.5 3.3 1.2 1.5 1.8 2.5 3.3 5.0
1.2 (4) v (2) v (2) v (2) v (2) v (4)
1.5 (4) vvv (2) v (2) v (3) v
1.8 (4) v vv (2) v (2) v (3) v (3) v
2.5 (4) vvv (3) v (3) v (3) v
3.3 (4) v vv (3) v (3) v (3) v (3) vv
Notes to Table 2–18:
(1) To drive inputs higher than VCCIO but less than 4.0 V, disable the PCI clamping diode and select the Allow LVTTL
and LVCMOS input levels to overdrive input buffer option in the Quartus II software.
(2) The pin current may be slightly higher than the default value. You must verify that the driving device’s VOL
maximum and VOH minimum voltages do not violate the applicable Stratix II VIL maximum and VIH minimum
voltage specifications.
(3) Although VCCIO specifies the voltage necessary for the Stratix II device to drive out, a receiving device powered at
a different level can still interface with the Stratix II device if it has inputs that tolerate the VCCIO value.
(4) Stratix II devices do not support 1.2-V LVTTL and 1.2-V LVCMOS. Stratix II devices support 1.2-V HSTL.
Altera Corporation 2–95
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
For JTAG chains, the TDO pin of the first device drives the TDI pin of the
second device in the chain. The VCCSEL input on JTAG input I/O cells
(TCK, TMS, TDI, and TRST) is internally hardwired to GND selecting the
3.3-V/2.5-V input buffer powered by VCCPD. The ideal case is to have the
VCCIO of the TDO bank from the first device to match the VCCSEL settings
for TDI on the second device, but that may not be possible depending on
the application. Table 2–20 contains board design recommendations to
ensure proper JTAG chain operation.
Table 2–19. Board Design Recommendations for nCEO
nCE Input Buffer Power in I/O
Bank 3
Stratix II nCEO VCCIO Voltage Level in I/O Bank 7
VCCIO =
3.3 V
VCCIO =
2.5 V
VCCIO =
1.8 V
VCCIO =
1.5 V
VCCIO =
1.2 V
VCCSEL high
(VCCIO Bank 3 = 1.5 V) v(1), (2) v (3), (4) v (5) vv
VCCSEL high
(VCCIO Bank 3 = 1.8 V) v (1), (2) v (3), (4) vv
Level shifter
required
VCCSEL low
(nCE Powered by VCCPD = 3.3V) v v (4) v (6) Level shifter
required
Level shifter
required
Notes to Table 2–19:
(1) Input buffer is 3.3-V tolerant.
(2) The nCEO output buffer meets VOH (MIN) = 2.4 V.
(3) Input buffer is 2.5-V tolerant.
(4) The nCEO output buffer meets VOH (MIN) = 2.0 V.
(5) Input buffer is 1.8-V tolerant.
(6) An external 250-Ω pull-up resistor is not required, but recommended if signal levels on the board are not optimal.
Table 2–20. Supported TDO/TDI Voltage Combinations (Part 1 of 2)
Device TDI Input
Buffer Power
Stratix II TDO VCCIO Voltage Level in I/O Bank 4
VCCIO = 3.3 V VCCIO = 2.5 V VCCIO = 1.8 V VCCIO = 1.5 V VCCIO = 1.2 V
Stratix II Always
VCCPD (3.3V) v (1) v (2) v (3) Level shifter
required
Level shifter
required
2–96 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
High-Speed Differential I/O with DPA Support
High-Speed
Differential I/O
with DPA
Support
Stratix II devices contain dedicated circuitry for supporting differential
standards at speeds up to 1 Gbps. The LVDS and HyperTransport
differential I/O standards are supported in the Stratix II device. In
addition, the LVPECL I/O standard is supported on input and output
clock pins on the top and bottom I/O banks.
The high-speed differential I/O circuitry supports the following high
speed I/O interconnect standards and applications:
SPI-4 Phase 2 (POS-PHY Level 4)
SFI-4
Parallel RapidIO
HyperTransport technology
There are four dedicated high-speed PLLs in the EP2S15 to EP2S30
devices and eight dedicated high-speed PLLs in the EP2S60 to EP2S180
devices to multiply reference clocks and drive high-speed differential
SERDES channels.
Tables 2–21 through 2–26 show the number of channels that each fast PLL
can clock in each of the Stratix II devices. In Tables 2–21 through 2–26 the
first row for each transmitter or receiver provides the number of channels
driven directly by the PLL. The second row below it shows the maximum
channels a PLL can drive if cross bank channels are used from the
adjacent center PLL. For example, in the 484-pin FineLine BGA EP2S15
Non-Stratix II VCC = 3.3 V v (1) v (2) v (3) Level shifter
required
Level shifter
required
VCC = 2.5 V v (1), (4) v (2) v (3) Level shifter
required
Level shifter
required
VCC = 1.8 V v (1), (4) v (2), (5) vLevel shifter
required
Level shifter
required
VCC = 1.5 V v (1), (4) v (2), (5) v (6) vv
Notes to Table 2–20:
(1) The TDO output buffer meets VOH (MIN) = 2.4 V.
(2) The TDO output buffer meets VOH (MIN) = 2.0 V.
(3) An external 250-Ω pull-up resistor is not required, but recommended if signal levels on the board are not optimal.
(4) Input buffer must be 3.3-V tolerant.
(5) Input buffer must be 2.5-V tolerant.
(6) Input buffer must be 1.8-V tolerant.
Table 2–20. Supported TDO/TDI Voltage Combinations (Part 2 of 2)
Device TDI Input
Buffer Power
Stratix II TDO VCCIO Voltage Level in I/O Bank 4
VCCIO = 3.3 V VCCIO = 2.5 V VCCIO = 1.8 V VCCIO = 1.5 V VCCIO = 1.2 V
Altera Corporation 2–97
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
device, PLL 1 can drive a maximum of 10 transmitter channels in I/O
bank 1 or a maximum of 19 transmitter channels in I/O banks 1 and 2. The
Quartus II software may also merge receiver and transmitter PLLs when
a receiver is driving a transmitter. In this case, one fast PLL can drive both
the maximum numbers of receiver and transmitter channels.
Table 2–21. EP2S15 Device Differential Channels Note (1)
Package Transmitter/
Receiver
Total
Channels
Center Fast PLLs
PLL 1 PLL 2 PLL 3 PLL 4
484-pin FineLine BGA Transmitter 38 (2) 10 9 9 10
(3) 19 19 19 19
Receiver 42 (2) 11 10 10 11
(3) 21 21 21 21
672-pin FineLine BGA Transmitter 38 (2) 10 9 9 10
(3) 19 19 19 19
Receiver 42 (2) 11 10 10 11
(3) 21 21 21 21
Table 2–22. EP2S30 Device Differential Channels Note (1)
Package Transmitter/
Receiver
Total
Channels
Center Fast PLLs
PLL 1 PLL 2 PLL 3 PLL 4
484-pin FineLine BGA Transmitter 38 (2) 10 9 9 10
(3) 19 19 19 19
Receiver 42 (2) 11 10 10 11
(3) 21 21 21 21
672-pin FineLine BGA Transmitter 58 (2) 16 13 13 16
(3) 29 29 29 29
Receiver 62 (2) 17 14 14 17
(3) 31 31 31 31
2–98 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
High-Speed Differential I/O with DPA Support
Table 2–23. EP2S60 Differential Channels Note (1)
Package Transmitter/
Receiver
Total
Channels
Center Fast PLLs Corner Fast PLLs (4)
PLL 1 PLL 2 PLL 3 PLL 4 PLL 7 PLL 8 PLL 9 PLL 10
484-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 38 (2) 10 9 9 10 10 9 9 10
(3) 19 19 19 19 - - - -
Receiver 42 (2) 11 10 10 11 11 10 10 11
(3) 21 21 21 21 - - - -
672-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 58 (2) 16 13 13 16 16 13 13 16
(3) 29 29 29 29 - - - -
Receiver 62 (2) 17 14 14 17 17 14 14 17
(3) 31 31 31 31 - - - -
1,020-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 84 (2) 21 21 21 21 21 21 21 21
(3) 42 42 42 42 - - - -
Receiver 84 (2) 21 21 21 21 21 21 21 21
(3) 42 42 42 42 - - - -
Table 2–24. EP2S90 Differential Channels Note (1)
Package Transmitter/
Receiver
Total
Channels
Center Fast PLLs Corner Fast PLLs (4)
PLL 1 PLL 2 PLL 3 PLL 4 PLL 7 PLL 8 PLL 9 PLL 10
484-pin Hybrid
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 38 (2) 10 9 9 10 - - - -
(3) 19 19 19 19 - - - -
Receiver 42 (2) 11 10 10 11 - - - -
(3) 21 21 21 21 - - - -
780-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 64 (2) 16 16 16 16 - - -
(3) 32 32 32 32 - - - -
Receiver 68 (2) 17 17 17 17 - - - -
(3) 34 34 34 34 - - -
1,020-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 90 (2) 23 22 22 23 23 22 22 23
(3) 45 45 45 45 - - - -
Receiver 94 (2) 23 24 24 23 23 24 24 23
(3) 46 46 46 46 - - - -
1,508-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 118 (2) 30 29 29 30 30 29 29 30
(3) 59 59 59 59 - - - -
Receiver 118 (2) 30 29 29 30 30 29 29 30
(3) 59 59 59 59 - - - -
Altera Corporation 2–99
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Table 2–25. EP2S130 Differential Channels Note (1)
Package Transmitter/
Receiver
Total
Channels
Center Fast PLLs Corner Fast PLLs (4)
PLL 1 PLL 2 PLL 3 PLL 4 PLL 7 PLL 8 PLL 9 PLL 10
780-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 64 (2) 16 16 16 16 - - -
(3) 32 32 32 32 - - - -
Receiver 68 (2) 17 17 17 17 - - - -
(3) 34 34 34 34 - - -
1,020-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 88 (2) 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22
(3) 44 44 44 44 - - - -
Receiver 92 (2) 23 23 23 23 23 23 23 23
(3) 46 46 46 46 - - - -
1,508-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 156 (2) 37 41 41 37 37 41 41 37
(3) 78 78 78 78 - - - -
Receiver 156 (2) 37 41 41 37 37 41 41 37
(3) 78 78 78 78 - - - -
Table 2–26. EP2S180 Differential Channels Note (1)
Package Transmitter/
Receiver
Total
Channels
Center Fast PLLs Corner Fast PLLs (4)
PLL 1 PLL 2 PLL 3 PLL 4 PLL 7 PLL 8 PLL 9 PLL 10
1,020-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 88 (2) 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22
(3) 44 44 44 44 - - - -
Receiver 92 (2) 23 23 23 23 23 23 23 23
(3) 46 46 46 46 - - - -
1,508-pin
FineLine BGA
Transmitter 156 (2) 37 41 41 37 37 41 41 37
(3) 78 78 78 78 - - - -
Receiver 156 (2) 37 41 41 37 37 41 41 37
(3) 78 78 78 78 - - - -
Notes to Tables 2–21 to 2–26:
(1) The total number of receiver channels includes the four non-dedicated clock channels that can be optionally used
as data channels.
(2) This is the maximum number of channels the PLLs can directly drive.
(3) This is the maximum number of channels if the device uses cross bank channels from the adjacent center PLL.
(4) The channels accessible by the center fast PLL overlap with the channels accessible by the corner fast PLL.
Therefore, the total number of channels is not the addition of the number of channels accessible by PLLs 1, 2, 3, and
4 with the number of channels accessible by PLLs 7, 8, 9, and 10.
2–100 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
High-Speed Differential I/O with DPA Support
Dedicated Circuitry with DPA Support
Stratix II devices support source-synchronous interfacing with LVDS or
HyperTransport signaling at up to 1 Gbps. Stratix II devices can transmit
or receive serial channels along with a low-speed or high-speed clock.
The receiving device PLL multiplies the clock by an integer factor W = 1
through 32. For example, a HyperTransport technology application
where the data rate is 1,000 Mbps and the clock rate is 500 MHz would
require that W be set to 2. The SERDES factor J determines the parallel
data width to deserialize from receivers or to serialize for transmitters.
The SERDES factor J can be set to 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10 and does not have to
equal the PLL clock-multiplication W value. A design using the dynamic
phase aligner also supports all of these J factor values. For a J factor of 1,
the Stratix II device bypasses the SERDES block. For a J factor of 2, the
Stratix II device bypasses the SERDES block, and the DDR input and
output registers are used in the IOE. Figure 2–58 shows the block diagram
of the Stratix II transmitter channel.
Figure 2–58. Stratix II Transmitter Channel
Each Stratix II receiver channel features a DPA block for phase detection
and selection, a SERDES, a synchronizer, and a data realigner circuit. You
can bypass the dynamic phase aligner without affecting the basic source-
synchronous operation of the channel. In addition, you can dynamically
switch between using the DPA block or bypassing the block via a control
signal from the logic array. Figure 2–59 shows the block diagram of the
Stratix II receiver channel.
Fast
PLL
refclk
diffioclk
Dedicated
Transmitter
Interface
Local
Interconnect
10
+
Up to 1 Gbps
load_en
Regional or
global clock
Data from R4, R24, C4, or
direct link interconnect
10
Altera Corporation 2–101
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–59. Stratix II Receiver Channel
An external pin or global or regional clock can drive the fast PLLs, which
can output up to three clocks: two multiplied high-speed clocks to drive
the SERDES block and/or external pin, and a low-speed clock to drive the
logic array. In addition, eight phase-shifted clocks from the VCO can feed
to the DPA circuitry.
fFor more information on the fast PLL, see the PLLs in Stratix II &
Stratix II GX Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook
or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook.
The eight phase-shifted clocks from the fast PLL feed to the DPA block.
The DPA block selects the closest phase to the center of the serial data eye
to sample the incoming data. This allows the source-synchronous
circuitry to capture incoming data correctly regardless of the channel-to-
channel or clock-to-channel skew. The DPA block locks to a phase closest
to the serial data phase. The phase-aligned DPA clock is used to write the
data into the synchronizer.
The synchronizer sits between the DPA block and the data realignment
and SERDES circuitry. Since every channel utilizing the DPA block can
have a different phase selected to sample the data, the synchronizer is
needed to synchronize the data to the high-speed clock domain of the
data realignment and the SERDES circuitry.
+
Fast
PLL
refclk
load_en
diffioclk
Regional or
global clock
Data to R4, R24, C4, or
direct link interconnect
Up to 1 Gbps
10
Dedicated
Receiver
Interface
Eight Phase Clocks
data retimed_data
DPA_clk
DPA
Synchronizer
8
DQ
Data Realignment
Circuitry
2–102 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
High-Speed Differential I/O with DPA Support
For high-speed source synchronous interfaces such as POS-PHY 4,
Parallel RapidIO, and HyperTransport, the source synchronous clock rate
is not a byte- or SERDES-rate multiple of the data rate. Byte alignment is
necessary for these protocols since the source synchronous clock does not
provide a byte or word boundary since the clock is one half the data rate,
not one eighth. The Stratix II device’s high-speed differential I/O
circuitry provides dedicated data realignment circuitry for user-
controlled byte boundary shifting. This simplifies designs while saving
ALM resources. You can use an ALM-based state machine to signal the
shift of receiver byte boundaries until a specified pattern is detected to
indicate byte alignment.
Fast PLL & Channel Layout
The receiver and transmitter channels are interleaved such that each I/O
bank on the left and right side of the device has one receiver channel and
one transmitter channel per LAB row. Figure 2–60 shows the fast PLL and
channel layout in the EP2S15 and EP2S30 devices. Figure 2–61 shows the
fast PLL and channel layout in the EP2S60 to EP2S180 devices.
Figure 2–60. Fast PLL & Channel Layout in the EP2S15 & EP2S30 Devices Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–60:
(1) See Table 2–21 for the number of channels each device supports.
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
Fast
PLL 1
Fast
PLL 2
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
Fast
PLL 4
Fast
PLL 3
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
Quadrant
Quadrant
Quadrant
Quadrant
4
4
4 4
4
4
2
2
2
2
Altera Corporation 2–103
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
Figure 2–61. Fast PLL & Channel Layout in the EP2S60 to EP2S180 Devices Note (1)
Note to Figure 2–61:
(1) See Tables 2–22 through 2–26 for the number of channels each device supports.
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
Fast
PLL 1
Fast
PLL 2
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
Fast
PLL 4
Fast
PLL 7
Fast
PLL 10
Fast
PLL 3
LVDS
Clock
DPA
Clock
Quadrant
Quadrant
Quadrant
Quadrant
4
4
2
4 4
4
4
2
2
2
2
2
Fast
PLL 8
Fast
PLL 9
22
2–104 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Document Revision History
Document
Revision History
Table 2–27 shows the revision history for this chapter.
Table 2–27. Document Revision History (Part 1 of 2)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
May 2007, v4.3 Updated “Clock Control Block” section.
Updated note in the “Clock Control Block” section.
Deleted Tables 2-11 and 2-12.
Updated notes to:
Figure 2–41
Figure 2–42
Figure 2–43
Figure 2–45
Updated notes to Table 2–18.
Moved Document Revision History to end of the chapter.
August 2006,
v4.2
Updated Table 2–18 with note.
April 2006,
v4.1
Updated Table 2–13.
Removed Note 2 from Table 2–16.
Updated “On-Chip Termination” section and Table 2–19 to
include parallel termination with calibration information.
Added new “On-Chip Parallel Termination with Calibration”
section.
Updated Figure 2–44.
Added parallel on-
chip termination
description and
specification.
Changed RCLK
names to match the
Quartus II software in
Table 2–13.
December
2005, v4.0
Updated “Clock Control Block” section.
July 2005, v3.1 Updated HyperTransport technology information in Table 2–18.
Updated HyperTransport technology information in
Figure 2–57.
Added information on the asynchronous clear signal.
May 2005, v3.0 Updated “Functional Description” section.
Updated Table 2–3.
Updated “Clock Control Block” section.
Updated Tables 2–17 through 2–19.
Updated Tables 2–20 through 2–22.
Updated Figure 2–57.
March 2005,
2.1
Updated “Functional Description” section.
Updated Table 2–3.
Altera Corporation 2–105
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Stratix II Architecture
January 2005,
v2.0
Updated the “MultiVolt I/O Interface” and “TriMatrix Memory”
sections.
Updated Tables 2–3, 2–17, and 2–19.
October 2004,
v1.2
Updated Tables 2–9, 2–16, 2–26, and 2–27.
July 2004, v1.1 Updated note to Tables 2–9 and 2–16.
Updated Tables 2–16, 2–17, 2–18, 2–19, and 2–20.
Updated Figures 2–41, 2–42, and 2–57.
Removed 3 from list of SERDES factor J.
Updated “High-Speed Differential I/O with DPA Support”
section.
In “Dedicated Circuitry with DPA Support” section, removed
XSBI and changed RapidIO to Parallel RapidIO.
February 2004,
v1.0
Added document to the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 2–27. Document Revision History (Part 2 of 2)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
2–106 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Document Revision History
Altera Corporation 3–1
May 2007
3. Configuration & Testing
IEEE Std. 1149.1
JTAG Boundary-
Scan Support
All Stratix®II devices provide Joint Test Action Group (JTAG)
boundary-scan test (BST) circuitry that complies with the IEEE
Std. 1149.1. JTAG boundary-scan testing can be performed either before
or after, but not during configuration. Stratix II devices can also use the
JTAG port for configuration with the Quartus®II software or hardware
using either Jam Files (.jam) or Jam Byte-Code Files (.jbc).
Stratix II devices support IOE I/O standard setting reconfiguration
through the JTAG BST chain. The JTAG chain can update the I/O
standard for all input and output pins any time before or during user
mode through the CONFIG_IO instruction. You can use this capability
for JTAG testing before configuration when some of the Stratix II pins
drive or receive from other devices on the board using voltage-referenced
standards. Because the Stratix II device may not be configured before
JTAG testing, the I/O pins may not be configured for appropriate
electrical standards for chip-to-chip communication. Programming those
I/O standards via JTAG allows you to fully test I/O connections to other
devices.
A device operating in JTAG mode uses four required pins, TDI,TDO, TMS,
and TCK, and one optional pin, TRST. The TCK pin has an internal weak
pull-down resistor, while the TDI,TMS and TRST pins have weak internal
pull-ups. The JTAG input pins are powered by the 3.3-V VCCPD pins. The
TDO output pin is powered by the VCCIO power supply of bank 4.
Stratix II devices also use the JTAG port to monitor the logic operation of
the device with the SignalTap®II embedded logic analyzer. Stratix II
devices support the JTAG instructions shown in Table 3–1.
1Stratix II, Stratix, Cyclone®II, and Cyclone devices must be
within the first 17 devices in a JTAG chain. All of these devices
have the same JTAG controller. If any of the Stratix II, Stratix,
Cyclone II, or Cyclone devices are in the 18th of further position,
they fail configuration. This does not affect SignalTap II.
The Stratix II device instruction register length is 10 bits and the
USERCODE register length is 32 bits. Tables 3–2 and 3–3 show the
boundary-scan register length and device IDCODE information for
Stratix II devices.
SII51003-4.2
3–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
IEEE Std. 1149.1 JTAG Boundary-Scan Support
Table 3–1. Stratix II JTAG Instructions
JTAG Instruction Instruction Code Description
SAMPLE/PRELOAD 00 0000 0101 Allows a snapshot of signals at the device pins to be captured and
examined during normal device operation, and permits an initial
data pattern to be output at the device pins. Also used by the
SignalTap II embedded logic analyzer.
EXTEST(1) 00 0000 1111 Allows the external circuitry and board-level interconnects to be
tested by forcing a test pattern at the output pins and capturing test
results at the input pins.
BYPASS 11 1111 1111 Places the 1-bit bypass register between the TDI and TDO pins,
which allows the BST data to pass synchronously through selected
devices to adjacent devices during normal device operation.
USERCODE 00 0000 0111 Selects the 32-bit USERCODE register and places it between the
TDI and TDO pins, allowing the USERCODE to be serially shifted
out of TDO.
IDCODE 00 0000 0110 Selects the IDCODE register and places it between TDI and TDO,
allowing the IDCODE to be serially shifted out of TDO.
HIGHZ (1) 00 0000 1011 Places the 1-bit bypass register between the TDI and TDO pins,
which allows the BST data to pass synchronously through selected
devices to adjacent devices during normal device operation, while
tri-stating all of the I/O pins.
CLAMP (1) 00 0000 1010 Places the 1-bit bypass register between the TDI and TDO pins,
which allows the BST data to pass synchronously through selected
devices to adjacent devices during normal device operation while
holding I/O pins to a state defined by the data in the boundary-scan
register.
ICR instructions Used when configuring a Stratix II device via the JTAG port with a
USB Blaster, MasterBlaster™, ByteBlasterMV™, or ByteBlaster II
download cable, or when using a .jam or .jbc via an embedded
processor or JRunner.
PULSE_NCONFIG 00 0000 0001 Emulates pulsing the nCONFIG pin low to trigger reconfiguration
even though the physical pin is unaffected.
CONFIG_IO (2) 00 0000 1101 Allows configuration of I/O standards through the JTAG chain for
JTAG testing. Can be executed before, during, or after
configuration. Stops configuration if executed during configuration.
Once issued, the CONFIG_IO instruction holds nSTATUS low to
reset the configuration device. nSTATUS is held low until the IOE
configuration register is loaded and the TAP controller state
machine transitions to the UPDATE_DR state.
SignalTap II
instructions
Monitors internal device operation with the SignalTap II embedded
logic analyzer.
Notes to Tab l e 3 1 :
(1) Bus hold and weak pull-up resistor features override the high-impedance state of HIGHZ, CLAMP, and EXTEST.
(2) For more information on using the CONFIG_IO instruction, see the MorphIO: An I/O Reconfiguration Solution for
Altera Devices White Paper.
Altera Corporation 3–3
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
The Quartus II software has an Auto Usercode feature where you can
choose to use the checksum value of a programming file as the JTAG user
code. If selected, the checksum is automatically loaded to the USERCODE
register. Turn on the Auto Usercode option by clicking Device & Pin
Options, then General, in the Settings dialog box (Assignments menu).
1Stratix, Stratix II, Cyclone, and Cyclone II devices must be
within the first 17 devices in a JTAG chain. All of these devices
have the same JTAG controller. If any of the Stratix, Stratix II,
Cyclone, and Cyclone II devices are in the 18th or after they fail
configuration. This does not affect SignalTap II.
Table 3–2. Stratix II Boundary-Scan Register Length
Device Boundary-Scan Register Length
EP2S15 1,140
EP2S30 1,692
EP2S60 2,196
EP2S90 2,748
EP2S130 3,420
EP2S180 3,948
Table 3–3. 32-Bit Stratix II Device IDCODE
Device
IDCODE (32 Bits) (1)
Version
(4 Bits) Part Number (16 Bits) Manufacturer Identity (11
Bits) LSB (1 Bit) (2)
EP2S15 0000 0010 0000 1001 0001 000 0110 1110 1
EP2S30 0000 0010 0000 1001 0010 000 0110 1110 1
EP2S60 0001 0010 0000 1001 0011 000 0110 1110 1
EP2S90 0000 0010 0000 1001 0100 000 0110 1110 1
EP2S130 0000 0010 0000 1001 0101 000 0110 1110 1
EP2S180 0000 0010 0000 1001 0110 000 0110 1110 1
Notes to Tab l e 3 3 :
(1) The most significant bit (MSB) is on the left.
(2) The IDCODE's least significant bit (LSB) is always 1.
3–4 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
SignalTap II Embedded Logic Analyzer
fFor more information on JTAG, see the following documents:
The IEEE Std. 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-Scan Testing for Stratix II &
Stratix II GX Devices chapter of the Stratix II Device Handbook,
Volume 2 or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook, Volume 2
Jam Programming & Test Language Specification
SignalTap II
Embedded Logic
Analyzer
Stratix II devices feature the SignalTap II embedded logic analyzer, which
monitors design operation over a period of time through the IEEE
Std. 1149.1 (JTAG) circuitry. You can analyze internal logic at speed
without bringing internal signals to the I/O pins. This feature is
particularly important for advanced packages, such as FineLine BGA®
packages, because it can be difficult to add a connection to a pin during
the debugging process after a board is designed and manufactured.
Configuration The logic, circuitry, and interconnects in the Stratix II architecture are
configured with CMOS SRAM elements. Altera® FPGA devices are
reconfigurable and every device is tested with a high coverage
production test program so you do not have to perform fault testing and
can instead focus on simulation and design verification.
Stratix II devices are configured at system power-up with data stored in
an Altera configuration device or provided by an external controller (e.g.,
a MAX®II device or microprocessor). Stratix II devices can be configured
using the fast passive parallel (FPP), active serial (AS), passive serial (PS),
passive parallel asynchronous (PPA), and JTAG configuration schemes.
The Stratix II device’s optimized interface allows microprocessors to
configure it serially or in parallel, and synchronously or asynchronously.
The interface also enables microprocessors to treat Stratix II devices as
memory and configure them by writing to a virtual memory location,
making reconfiguration easy.
In addition to the number of configuration methods supported, Stratix II
devices also offer the design security, decompression, and remote system
upgrade features. The design security feature, using configuration
bitstream encryption and AES technology, provides a mechanism to
protect your designs. The decompression feature allows Stratix II FPGAs
to receive a compressed configuration bitstream and decompress this
data in real-time, reducing storage requirements and configuration time.
The remote system upgrade feature allows real-time system upgrades
from remote locations of your Stratix II designs. For more information,
see “Configuration Schemes” on page 3–7.
Altera Corporation 3–5
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
Operating Modes
The Stratix II architecture uses SRAM configuration elements that require
configuration data to be loaded each time the circuit powers up. The
process of physically loading the SRAM data into the device is called
configuration. During initialization, which occurs immediately after
configuration, the device resets registers, enables I/O pins, and begins to
operate as a logic device. The I/O pins are tri-stated during power-up,
and before and during configuration. Together, the configuration and
initialization processes are called command mode. Normal device
operation is called user mode.
SRAM configuration elements allow Stratix II devices to be reconfigured
in-circuit by loading new configuration data into the device. With real-
time reconfiguration, the device is forced into command mode with a
device pin. The configuration process loads different configuration data,
reinitializes the device, and resumes user-mode operation. You can
perform in-field upgrades by distributing new configuration files either
within the system or remotely.
PORSEL is a dedicated input pin used to select POR delay times of 12 ms
or 100 ms during power-up. When the PORSEL pin is connected to
ground, the POR time is 100 ms; when the PORSEL pin is connected to
VCC, the POR time is 12 ms.
The nIO PULLUP pin is a dedicated input that chooses whether the
internal pull-ups on the user I/O pins and dual-purpose configuration
I/O pins (nCSO, ASDO, DATA[7..0], nWS, nRS, RDYnBSY, nCS, CS,
RUnLU, PGM[2..0], CLKUSR, INIT_DONE, DEV_OE, DEV_CLR) are on or
off before and during configuration. A logic high (1.5, 1.8, 2.5, 3.3 V) turns
off the weak internal pull-ups, while a logic low turns them on.
Stratix II devices also offer a new power supply, VCCPD, which must be
connected to 3.3 V in order to power the 3.3-V/2.5-V buffer available on
the configuration input pins and JTAG pins. VCCPD applies to all the JTAG
input pins (TCK, TMS, TDI, and TRST) and the configuration input pins
when VCCSEL is connected to ground. See Table 3–4 for more information
on the pins affected by VCCSEL.
The VCCSEL pin allows the VCCIO setting (of the banks where the
configuration inputs reside) to be independent of the voltage required by
the configuration inputs. Therefore, when selecting the VCCIO, the VIL and
VIH levels driven to the configuration inputs do not have to be a concern.
3–6 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Configuration
The PLL_ENA pin and the configuration input pins (Table 3–4) have a
dual buffer design: a 3.3-V/2.5-V input buffer and a 1.8-V/1.5-V input
buffer. The VCCSEL input pin selects which input buffer is used. The 3.3-
V/2.5-V input buffer is powered by VCCPD, while the 1.8-V/1.5-V input
buffer is powered by VCCIO. Table 3–4 shows the pins affected by VCCSEL.
VCCSEL is sampled during power-up. Therefore, the VCCSEL setting
cannot change on the fly or during a reconfiguration. The VCCSEL input
buffer is powered by VCCINT and must be hardwired to VCCPD or ground.
A logic high VCCSEL connection selects the 1.8-V/1.5-V input buffer, and
a logic low selects the 3.3-V/2.5-V input buffer. VCCSEL should be set to
comply with the logic levels driven out of the configuration device or
MAX® II/microprocessor.
If you need to support configuration input voltages of 3.3 V/2.5 V, you
should set the VCCSEL to a logic low; you can set the VCCIO of the I/O
bank that contains the configuration inputs to any supported voltage. If
Table 3–4. Pins Affected by the Voltage Level at VCCSEL
Pin VCCSEL = LOW (connected
to GND)
VCCSEL = HIGH (connected
to VCCPD)
nSTATUS (when
used as an input)
3.3/2.5-V input buffer is
selected. Input buffer is
powered by VCCPD.
1.8/1.5-V input buffer is
selected. Input buffer is
powered by VCCIO of the I/O
bank.
nCONFIG
CONF_DONE
(when used as an
input)
DATA[7..0]
nCE
DCLK (when used
as an input)
CS
nWS
nRS
nCS
CLKUSR
DEV_OE
DEV_CLRn
RUnLU
PLL_ENA
Altera Corporation 3–7
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
you need to support configuration input voltages of 1.8 V/1.5 V, you
should set the VCCSEL to a logic high and the VCCIO of the bank that
contains the configuration inputs to 1.8 V/1.5 V.
fFor more information on multi-volt support, including information on
using TDO and nCEO in multi-volt systems, refer to the Stratix II
Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Configuration Schemes
You can load the configuration data for a Stratix II device with one of five
configuration schemes (see Table 3–5), chosen on the basis of the target
application. You can use a configuration device, intelligent controller, or
the JTAG port to configure a Stratix II device. A configuration device can
automatically configure a Stratix II device at system power-up.
You can configure multiple Stratix II devices in any of the five
configuration schemes by connecting the configuration enable (nCE) and
configuration enable output (nCEO) pins on each device.
Stratix II FPGAs offer the following:
Configuration data decompression to reduce configuration file
storage
Design security using configuration data encryption to protect your
designs
Remote system upgrades for remotely updating your Stratix II
designs
Table 3–5 summarizes which configuration features can be used in each
configuration scheme.
Table 3–5. Stratix II Configuration Features (Part 1 of 2)
Configuration
Scheme Configuration Method Design Security Decompression Remote System
Upgrade
FPP MAX II device or microprocessor and
flash device v (1) v (1) v
Enhanced configuration device v (2) v
AS Serial configuration device vvv (3)
PS MAX II device or microprocessor and
flash device vvv
Enhanced configuration device vvv
Download cable (4) vv
3–8 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Configuration
fSee the Configuring Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter in volume 2
of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook for
more information about configuration schemes in Stratix II and
Stratix II GX devices.
Device Security Using Configuration Bitstream Encryption
Stratix II FPGAs are the industry’s first FPGAs with the ability to decrypt
a configuration bitstream using the Advanced Encryption Standard
(AES) algorithm. When using the design security feature, a 128-bit
security key is stored in the Stratix II FPGA. To successfully configure a
Stratix II FPGA that has the design security feature enabled, it must be
configured with a configuration file that was encrypted using the same
128-bit security key. The security key can be stored in non-volatile
memory inside the Stratix II device. This non-volatile memory does not
require any external devices, such as a battery back-up, for storage.
PPA MAX II device or microprocessor and
flash device v
JTAG Download cable (4)
MAX II device or microprocessor and
flash device
Notes for Table 35 :
(1) In these modes, the host system must send a DCLK that is 4× the data rate.
(2) The enhanced configuration device decompression feature is available, while the Stratix II decompression feature
is not available.
(3) Only remote update mode is supported when using the AS configuration scheme. Local update mode is not
supported.
(4) The supported download cables include the Altera USB Blaster universal serial bus (USB) port download cable,
MasterBlaster serial/USB communications cable, ByteBlaster II parallel port download cable, and the
ByteBlasterMV parallel port download cable.
Table 3–5. Stratix II Configuration Features (Part 2 of 2)
Configuration
Scheme Configuration Method Design Security Decompression Remote System
Upgrade
Altera Corporation 3–9
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
1An encryption configuration file is the same size as a non-
encryption configuration file. When using a serial configuration
scheme such as passive serial (PS) or active serial (AS),
configuration time is the same whether or not the design
security feature is enabled. If the fast passive parallel (FPP)
scheme us used with the design security or decompression
feature, a 4× DCLK is required. This results in a slower
configuration time when compared to the configuration time of
an FPGA that has neither the design security, nor
decompression feature enabled. For more information about
this feature, refer to AN 341: Using the Design Security Feature in
Stratix II Devices. Contact your local Altera sales representative
to request this document.
Device Configuration Data Decompression
Stratix II FPGAs support decompression of configuration data, which
saves configuration memory space and time. This feature allows you to
store compressed configuration data in configuration devices or other
memory, and transmit this compressed bit stream to Stratix II FPGAs.
During configuration, the Stratix II FPGA decompresses the bit stream in
real time and programs its SRAM cells.
Stratix II FPGAs support decompression in the FPP (when using a
MAX II device/microprocessor and flash memory), AS and PS
configuration schemes. Decompression is not supported in the PPA
configuration scheme nor in JTAG-based configuration.
Remote System Upgrades
Shortened design cycles, evolving standards, and system deployments in
remote locations are difficult challenges faced by modern system
designers. Stratix II devices can help effectively deal with these
challenges with their inherent re-programmability and dedicated
circuitry to perform remote system updates. Remote system updates help
deliver feature enhancements and bug fixes without costly recalls, reduce
time to market, and extend product life.
Stratix II FPGAs feature dedicated remote system upgrade circuitry to
facilitate remote system updates. Soft logic (Nios® processor or user logic)
implemented in the Stratix II device can download a new configuration
image from a remote location, store it in configuration memory, and direct
the dedicated remote system upgrade circuitry to initiate a
reconfiguration cycle. The dedicated circuitry performs error detection
during and after the configuration process, recovers from any error
condition by reverting back to a safe configuration image, and provides
3–10 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Configuration
error status information. This dedicated remote system upgrade circuitry
avoids system downtime and is the critical component for successful
remote system upgrades.
RSC is supported in the following Stratix II configuration schemes: FPP,
AS, PS, and PPA. RSC can also be implemented in conjunction with
advanced Stratix II features such as real-time decompression of
configuration data and design security using AES for secure and efficient
field upgrades.
fSee the Remote System Upgrades With Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices
chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device Handbook or the Stratix II GX
Device Handbook for more information about remote configuration in
Stratix II devices.
Configuring Stratix II FPGAs with JRunner
JRunner is a software driver that configures Altera FPGAs, including
Stratix II FPGAs, through the ByteBlaster II or ByteBlasterMV cables in
JTAG mode. The programming input file supported is in Raw Binary File
(.rbf) format. JRunner also requires a Chain Description File (.cdf)
generated by the Quartus II software. JRunner is targeted for embedded
JTAG configuration. The source code is developed for the Windows NT
operating system (OS), but can be customized to run on other platforms.
fFor more information on the JRunner software driver, see the JRunner
Software Driver: An Embedded Solution to the JTAG Configuration White
Paper and the source files on the Altera web site (www.altera.com).
Programming Serial Configuration Devices with SRunner
A serial configuration device can be programmed in-system by an
external microprocessor using SRunner. SRunner is a software driver
developed for embedded serial configuration device programming that
can be easily customized to fit in different embedded systems. SRunner is
able to read a .rpd file (Raw Programming Data) and write to the serial
configuration devices. The serial configuration device programming time
using SRunner is comparable to the programming time when using the
Quartus II software.
fFor more information about SRunner, see the SRunner: An Embedded
Solution for EPCS Programming White Paper and the source code on the
Altera web site at www.altera.com.
fFor more information on programming serial configuration devices, see
the Serial Configuration Devices (EPCS1 & EPCS4) Data Sheet in the
Configuration Handbook.
Altera Corporation 3–11
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
Configuring Stratix II FPGAs with the MicroBlaster Driver
The MicroBlasterTM software driver supports an RBF programming input
file and is ideal for embedded FPP or PS configuration. The source code
is developed for the Windows NT operating system, although it can be
customized to run on other operating systems. For more information on
the MicroBlaster software driver, see the Configuring the MicroBlaster Fast
Passive Parallel Software Driver White Paper or the Configuring the
MicroBlaster Passive Serial Software Driver White Paper on the Altera web
site (www.altera.com).
PLL Reconfiguration
The phase-locked loops (PLLs) in the Stratix II device family support
reconfiguration of their multiply, divide, VCO-phase selection, and
bandwidth selection settings without reconfiguring the entire device. You
can use either serial data from the logic array or regular I/O pins to
program the PLL’s counter settings in a serial chain. This option provides
considerable flexibility for frequency synthesis, allowing real-time
variation of the PLL frequency and delay. The rest of the device is
functional while reconfiguring the PLL.
fSee the PLLs in Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter in volume 2 of
the Stratix II Device Handbook or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook for
more information on Stratix II PLLs.
Temperature
Sensing Diode
(TSD)
Stratix II devices include a diode-connected transistor for use as a
temperature sensor in power management. This diode is used with an
external digital thermometer device. These devices steer bias current
through the Stratix II diode, measuring forward voltage and converting
this reading to temperature in the form of an 8-bit signed number (7 bits
plus sign). The external device's output represents the junction
temperature of the Stratix II device and can be used for intelligent power
management.
The diode requires two pins (tempdiodep and tempdioden) on the
Stratix II device to connect to the external temperature-sensing device, as
shown in Figure 3–1. The temperature sensing diode is a passive element
and therefore can be used before the Stratix II device is powered.
3–12 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Temperature Sensing Diode (TSD)
Figure 3–1. External Temperature-Sensing Diode
Table 3–6 shows the specifications for bias voltage and current of the
Stratix II temperature sensing diode.
Table 3–6. Temperature-Sensing Diode Electrical Characteristics
Parameter Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
IBIAS high 80 100 120 μA
IBIAS low 8 10 12 μA
VBP - VBN 0.3 0.9 V
VBN 0.7 V
Series resistance 3 Ω
Stratix II Device
Temperature-Sensing
Device
tempdiodep
tempdioden
Altera Corporation 3–13
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
The temperature-sensing diode works for the entire operating range, as
shown in Figure 3–2.
Figure 3–2. Temperature vs. Temperature-Sensing Diode Voltage
The temperature sensing diode is a very sensitive circuit which can be
influenced by noise coupled from other traces on the board, and possibly
within the device package itself, depending on device usage. The
interfacing device registers temperature based on milivolts of difference
as seen at the TSD. Switching I/O near the TSD pins can affect the
temperature reading. Altera recommends you take temperature readings
during periods of no activity in the device (for example, standby mode
where no clocks are toggling in the device), such as when the nearby I/Os
are at a DC state, and disable clock networks in the device.
Automated
Single Event
Upset (SEU)
Detection
Stratix II devices offer on-chip circuitry for automated checking of single
event upset (SEU) detection. Some applications that require the device to
operate error free at high elevations or in close proximity to Earth’s North
or South Pole require periodic checks to ensure continued data integrity.
The error detection cyclic redundancy check (CRC) feature controlled by
0.90
0.85
0.95
0.75
0.65
Voltage
(Across Diode)
Temperature (˚C)
0.55
0.45
0.60
0.50
0.40
0.70
0.80
–55 –30 –5 20 45 70 95 120
10 μA Bias Current
100 μA Bias Current
3–14 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Document Revision History
the Device & Pin Options dialog box in the Quartus II software uses a
32-bit CRC circuit to ensure data reliability and is one of the best options
for mitigating SEU.
You can implement the error detection CRC feature with existing circuitry
in Stratix II devices, eliminating the need for external logic. For Stratix II
devices, CRC is computed by the device during configuration and
checked against an automatically computed CRC during normal
operation. The CRC_ERROR pin reports a soft error when configuration
SRAM data is corrupted, triggering device reconfiguration.
Custom-Built Circuitry
Dedicated circuitry is built in the Stratix II devices to perform error
detection automatically. This error detection circuitry in Stratix II devices
constantly checks for errors in the configuration SRAM cells while the
device is in user mode. You can monitor one external pin for the error and
use it to trigger a re-configuration cycle. You can select the desired time
between checks by adjusting a built-in clock divider.
Software Interface
In the Quartus II software version 4.1 and later, you can turn on the
automated error detection CRC feature in the Device & Pin Options
dialog box. This dialog box allows you to enable the feature and set the
internal frequency of the CRC between 400 kHz to 50 MHz. This controls
the rate that the CRC circuitry verifies the internal configuration SRAM
bits in the FPGA device.
For more information on CRC, refer to AN 357: Error Detection Using CRC
in Altera FPGA Devices.
Document
Revision History
Table 3–7 shows the revision history for this chapter.
Table 3–7. Document Revision History (Part 1 of 2)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
May 2007, v4.2 Moved Document Revision History section to the end
of the chapter.
Updated the “Temperature Sensing Diode (TSD)”
section.
Altera Corporation 3–15
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Configuration & Testing
April 2006,
v4.1
Updated “Device Security Using Configuration
Bitstream Encryption” section.
December
2005, v4.0
Updated “Software Interface” section.
May 2005, v3.0 Updated “IEEE Std. 1149.1 JTAG Boundary-Scan
Support” section.
Updated “Operating Modes” section.
January 2005,
v2.1
Updated JTAG chain device limits.
January 2005,
v2.0
Updated Table 3–3.
July 2004, v1.1 Added “Automated Single Event Upset (SEU)
Detection” section.
Updated “Device Security Using Configuration
Bitstream Encryption” section.
Updated Figure 3–2.
February 2004,
v1.0
Added document to the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 3–7. Document Revision History (Part 2 of 2)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
3–16 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Document Revision History
Altera Corporation 4–1
May 2007
4. Hot Socketing &
Power-On Reset
Stratix® II devices offer hot socketing, which is also known as hot plug-in
or hot swap, and power sequencing support without the use of any
external devices. You can insert or remove a Stratix II board in a system
during system operation without causing undesirable effects to the
running system bus or the board that was inserted into the system.
The hot socketing feature also removes some of the difficulty when you
use Stratix II devices on printed circuit boards (PCBs) that also contain a
mixture of 5.0-, 3.3-, 2.5-, 1.8-, 1.5- and 1.2-V devices. With the Stratix II hot
socketing feature, you no longer need to ensure a proper power-up
sequence for each device on the board.
The Stratix II hot socketing feature provides:
Board or device insertion and removal without external components
or board manipulation
Support for any power-up sequence
Non-intrusive I/O buffers to system buses during hot insertion
This chapter also discusses the power-on reset (POR) circuitry in Stratix II
devices. The POR circuitry keeps the devices in the reset state until the
VCC is within operating range.
Stratix II
Hot-Socketing
Specifications
Stratix II devices offer hot socketing capability with all three features
listed above without any external components or special design
requirements. The hot socketing feature in Stratix II devices allows:
The device can be driven before power-up without any damage to
the device itself.
I/O pins remain tri-stated during power-up. The device does not
drive out before or during power-up, thereby affecting other buses in
operation.
Signal pins do not drive the VCCIO, VCCPD, or VCCINT power supplies.
External input signals to I/O pins of the device do not internally
power the VCCIO or VCCINT power supplies of the device via internal
paths within the device.
SII51004-3.2
4–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Stratix II Hot-Socketing Specifications
Devices Can Be Driven Before Power-Up
You can drive signals into the I/O pins, dedicated input pins and
dedicated clock pins of Stratix II devices before or during power-up or
power-down without damaging the device. Stratix II devices support any
power-up or power-down sequence (VCCIO, VCCINT, and VCCPD) in order
to simplify system level design.
I/O Pins Remain Tri-Stated During Power-Up
A device that does not support hot-socketing may interrupt system
operation or cause contention by driving out before or during power-up.
In a hot socketing situation, Stratix II device's output buffers are turned
off during system power-up or power-down. Stratix II device also does
not drive out until the device is configured and has attained proper
operating conditions.
Signal Pins Do Not Drive the VCCIO, VCCINT or VCCPD Power
Supplies
Devices that do not support hot-socketing can short power supplies
together when powered-up through the device signal pins. This irregular
power-up can damage both the driving and driven devices and can
disrupt card power-up.
Stratix II devices do not have a current path from I/O pins, dedicated
input pins, or dedicated clock pins to the VCCIO, VCCINT, or VCCPD pins
before or during power-up. A Stratix II device may be inserted into (or
removed from) a powered-up system board without damaging or
interfering with system-board operation. When hot-socketing, Stratix II
devices may have a minimal effect on the signal integrity of the
backplane.
1You can power up or power down the VCCIO, VCCINT, and VCCPD
pins in any sequence. The power supply ramp rates can range
from 100 μs to 100 ms. All VCC supplies must power down
within 100 ms of each other to prevent I/O pins from driving
out. During hot socketing, the I/O pin capacitance is less than 15
pF and the clock pin capacitance is less than 20 pF. Stratix II
devices meet the following hot socketing specification.
The hot socketing DC specification is: | IIOPIN | < 300 μA.
The hot socketing AC specification is: | IIOPIN | < 8 mA for 10 ns or
less.
Altera Corporation 4–3
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Hot Socketing & Power-On Reset
IIOPIN is the current at any user I/O pin on the device. This specification
takes into account the pin capacitance, but not board trace and external
loading capacitance. Additional capacitance for trace, connector, and
loading needs must be considered separately. For the AC specification,
the peak current duration is 10 ns or less because of power-up transients.
For more information, refer to the Hot-Socketing & Power-Sequencing
Feature & Testing for Altera Devices white paper.
A possible concern regarding hot-socketing is the potential for latch-up.
Latch-up can occur when electrical subsystems are hot-socketed into an
active system. During hot-socketing, the signal pins may be connected
and driven by the active system before the power supply can provide
current to the device's VCC and ground planes. This condition can lead to
latch-up and cause a low-impedance path from VCC to ground within the
device. As a result, the device extends a large amount of current, possibly
causing electrical damage. Nevertheless, Stratix II devices are immune to
latch-up when hot-socketing.
Hot Socketing
Feature
Implementation
in Stratix II
Devices
The hot socketing feature turns off the output buffer during the power-up
event (either VCCINT, VCCIO, or VCCPD supplies) or power down. The hot-
socket circuit will generate an internal HOTSCKT signal when either
VCCINT, VCCIO, or VCCPD is below threshold voltage. The HOTSCKT signal
will cut off the output buffer to make sure that no DC current (except for
weak pull up leaking) leaks through the pin. When VCC ramps up very
slowly, VCC is still relatively low even after the POR signal is released and
the configuration is finished. The CONF_DONE, nCEO, and nSTATUS pins
fail to respond, as the output buffer can not flip from the state set by the
hot socketing circuit at this low VCC voltage. Therefore, the hot socketing
circuit has been removed on these configuration pins to make sure that
they are able to operate during configuration. It is expected behavior for
these pins to drive out during power-up and power-down sequences.
Each I/O pin has the following circuitry shown in Figure 4–1.
4–4 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Hot Socketing Feature Implementation in Stratix II Devices
Figure 4–1. Hot Socketing Circuit Block Diagram for Stratix II Devices
The POR circuit monitors VCCINT voltage level and keeps I/O pins tri-
stated until the device is in user mode. The weak pull-up resistor (R) from
the I/O pin to VCCIO is present to keep the I/O pins from floating. The
3.3-V tolerance control circuit permits the I/O pins to be driven by 3.3 V
before VCCIO and/or VCCINT and/or VCCPD are powered, and it prevents
the I/O pins from driving out when the device is not in user mode. The
hot socket circuit prevents I/O pins from internally powering VCCIO,
VCCINT, and VCCPD when driven by external signals before the device is
powered.
Figure 4–2 shows a transistor level cross section of the Stratix II device
I/O buffers. This design ensures that the output buffers do not drive
when VCCIO is powered before VCCINT or if the I/O pad voltage is higher
than VCCIO. This also applies for sudden voltage spikes during hot
insertion. There is no current path from signal I/O pins to VCCINT or VCCIO
or VCCPD during hot insertion. The VPAD leakage current charges the 3.3-V
tolerant circuit capacitance.
Output Enable
Output
Hot Socket
Output
Pre-Driver
Voltage
Tolerance
Control
Power On
Reset
Monitor
Weak
Pull-Up
Resistor
PAD
Input Buffer
to Logic Array
R
Altera Corporation 4–5
May 2007 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
Hot Socketing & Power-On Reset
Figure 4–2. Transistor Level Diagram of FPGA Device I/O Buffers
Notes to Figure 4–2:
(1) This is the logic array signal or the larger of either the VCCIO or VPAD signal.
(2) This is the larger of either the VCCIO or VPAD signal.
Power-On Reset
Circuitry
Stratix II devices have a POR circuit to keep the whole device system in
reset state until the power supply voltage levels have stabilized during
power-up. The POR circuit monitors the VCCINT, VCCIO, and VCCPD voltage
levels and tri-states all the user I/O pins while VCC is ramping up until
normal user levels are reached. The POR circuitry also ensures that all
eight I/O bank VCCIO voltages, VCCPD voltage, as well as the logic array
VCCINT voltage, reach an acceptable level before configuration is
triggered. After the Stratix II device enters user mode, the POR circuit
continues to monitor the VCCINT voltage level so that a brown-out
condition during user mode can be detected. If there is a VCCINT voltage
sag below the Stratix II operational level during user mode, the POR
circuit resets the device.
When power is applied to a Stratix II device, a power-on-reset event
occurs if VCC reaches the recommended operating range within a certain
period of time (specified as a maximum VCC rise time). The maximum
VCC rise time for Stratix II device is 100 ms. Stratix II devices provide a
dedicated input pin (PORSEL) to select POR delay times of 12 or 100 ms
during power-up. When the PORSEL pin is connected to ground, the POR
time is 100 ms. When the PORSEL pin is connected to VCC, the POR time
is 12 ms.
Logic Array
Signal
(1) (2)
VCCIO
VPAD
n+ n+
n-well
n+p+p+
p-well
p-substrate
4–6 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 May 2007
Document Revision History
Document
Revision History
Table 4–1 shows the revision history for this chapter.
Table 4–1. Document Revision History
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
May 2007, v3.2 Moved the Document Revision History section to the
end of the chapter.
April 2006,
v3.1
Updated “Signal Pins Do Not Drive the VCCIO,
VCCINT or VCCPD Power Supplies” section.
Updated hot socketing AC
specification.
May 2005, v3.0 Updated “Signal Pins Do Not Drive the VCCIO,
VCCINT or VCCPD Power Supplies” section.
Removed information on ESD protection.
January 2005,
v2.1
Updated input rise and fall time.
January 2005,
v2.0
Updated the “Hot Socketing Feature Implementation in
Stratix II Devices”, “ESD Protection”, and “Power-On
Reset Circuitry” sections.
July 2004, v1.1 Updated all tables.
Added tables.
February 2004,
v1.0
Added document to the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Altera Corporation 5–1
April 2011
5. DC & Switching
Characteristics
Operating
Conditions
Stratix®II devices are offered in both commercial and industrial grades.
Industrial devices are offered in -4 speed grades and commercial devices
are offered in -3 (fastest), -4, -5 speed grades.
Tables 5–1 through 5–32 provide information about absolute maximum
ratings, recommended operating conditions, DC electrical characteristics,
and other specifications for Stratix II devices.
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 5–1 contains the absolute maximum ratings for the Stratix II device
family.
Table 5–1. Stratix II Device Absolute Maximum Ratings Notes (1), (2), (3)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCINT Supply voltage With respect to ground –0.5 1.8 V
VCCIO Supply voltage With respect to ground –0.5 4.6 V
VCCPD Supply voltage With respect to ground –0.5 4.6 V
VCCA Analog power supply for
PLLs
With respect to ground –0.5 1.8 V
VCCD Digital power supply for PLLs With respect to ground –0.5 1.8 V
VIDC input voltage (4) –0.5 4.6 V
IOUT DC output current, per pin –25 40 mA
TSTG Storage temperature No bias –65 150 °C
TJJunction temperature BGA packages under bias –55 125 °C
Notes to Tab l e s 5 1
(1) See the Operating Requirements for Altera Devices Data Sheet.
(2) Conditions beyond those listed in Table 51 may cause permanent damage to a device. Additionally, device
operation at the absolute maximum ratings for extended periods of time may have adverse affects on the device.
(3) Supply voltage specifications apply to voltage readings taken at the device pins, not at the power supply.
(4) During transitions, the inputs may overshoot to the voltage shown in Table 52 based upon the input duty cycle.
The DC case is equivalent to 100% duty cycle. During transitions, the inputs may undershoot to –2.0 V for input
currents less than 100 mA and periods shorter than 20 ns.
SII51005-4.5
5–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
Recommended Operating Conditions
Table 5–3 contains the Stratix II device family recommended operating
conditions.
Table 5–2. Maximum Duty Cycles in Voltage Transitions
Symbol Parameter Condition Maximum
Duty Cycles Unit
VIMaximum duty cycles
in voltage transitions
VI = 4.0 V 100 %
VI = 4.1 V 90 %
VI = 4.2 V 50 %
VI = 4.3 V 30 %
VI = 4.4 V 17 %
VI = 4.5 V 10 %
Table 5–3. Stratix II Device Recommended Operating Conditions (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCINT Supply voltage for internal logic 100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 1.15 1.25 V
VCCIO Supply voltage for input and
output buffers, 3.3-V operation
100 μs risetime 100 ms (3), (6) 3.135
(3.00)
3.465
(3.60)
V
Supply voltage for input and
output buffers, 2.5-V operation
100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 2.375 2.625 V
Supply voltage for input and
output buffers, 1.8-V operation
100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 1.71 1.89 V
Supply voltage for output buffers,
1.5-V operation
100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 1.425 1.575 V
Supply voltage for input and
output buffers, 1.2-V operation
100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 1.14 1.26 V
VCCPD Supply voltage for pre-drivers as
well as configuration and JTAG
I/O buffers.
100 μs risetime 100 ms (4) 3.135 3.465 V
VCCA Analog power supply for PLLs 100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 1.15 1.25 V
VCCD Digital power supply for PLLs 100 μs risetime 100 ms (3) 1.15 1.25 V
VIInput voltage (see Ta bl e 5 2 )(2), (5) –0.5 4.0 V
VOOutput voltage 0 VCCIO V
Altera Corporation 5–3
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
DC Electrical Characteristics
Table 5–4 shows the Stratix II device family DC electrical characteristics.
TJOperating junction temperature For commercial use 0 85 °C
For industrial use –40 100 °C
For military use (7) –55 125 °C
Notes to Tab l e 5 3 :
(1) Supply voltage specifications apply to voltage readings taken at the device pins, not at the power supply.
(2) During transitions, the inputs may overshoot to the voltage shown in Table 52 based upon the input duty cycle.
The DC case is equivalent to 100% duty cycle. During transitions, the inputs may undershoot to –2.0 V for input
currents less than 100 mA and periods shorter than 20 ns.
(3) Maximum VCC rise time is 100 ms, and VCC must rise monotonically from ground to VCC.
(4) VCCPD must ramp-up from 0 V to 3.3 V within 100 μs to 100 ms. If VCCPD is not ramped up within this specified
time, your Stratix II device does not configure successfully. If your system does not allow for a VCCPD ramp-up time
of 100 ms or less, you must hold nCONFIG low until all power supplies are reliable.
(5) All pins, including dedicated inputs, clock, I/O, and JTAG pins, may be driven before VCCINT, VCCPD, and VCCIO
are powered.
(6) VCCIO maximum and minimum conditions for PCI and PCI-X are shown in parentheses.
(7) For more information, refer to the Stratix II Military Temperature Range Support technical brief.
Table 5–3. Stratix II Device Recommended Operating Conditions (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
Table 5–4. Stratix II Device DC Operating Conditions (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
IIInput pin leakage current VI = VCCIOmax to 0 V (2) –10 10 μA
IOZ Tri-stated I/O pin
leakage current
VO = VCCIOmax to 0 V (2) –10 10 μA
ICCINT0 VCCINT supply current
(standby)
VI = ground, no
load, no toggling
inputs
TJ = 25° C
EP2S15 0.25 (3) A
EP2S30 0.30 (3) A
EP2S60 0.50 (3) A
EP2S90 0.62 (3) A
EP2S130 0.82 (3) A
EP2S180 1.12 (3) A
ICCPD0 VCCPD supply current
(standby)
VI = ground, no
load, no toggling
inputs
TJ = 25° C,
VCCPD = 3.3V
EP2S15 2.2 (3) mA
EP2S30 2.7 (3) mA
EP2S60 3.6 (3) mA
EP2S90 4.3 (3) mA
EP2S130 5.4 (3) mA
EP2S180 6.8 (3) mA
5–4 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
I/O Standard Specifications
Tables 5–5 through 5–32 show the Stratix II device family I/O standard
specifications.
ICCI00 VCCIO supply current
(standby)
VI = ground, no
load, no toggling
inputs
TJ = 25° C
EP2S15 4.0 (3) mA
EP2S30 4.0 (3) mA
EP2S60 4.0 (3) mA
EP2S90 4.0 (3) mA
EP2S130 4.0 (3) mA
EP2S180 4.0 (3) mA
RCONF (4) Value of I/O pin pull-up
resistor before and
during configuration
Vi = 0; VCCIO = 3.3 V 10 25 50 kΩ
Vi = 0; VCCIO = 2.5 V 15 35 70 kΩ
Vi = 0; VCCIO = 1.8 V 30 50 100 kΩ
Vi = 0; VCCIO = 1.5 V 40 75 150 kΩ
Vi = 0; VCCIO = 1.2 V 50 90 170 kΩ
Recommended value of
I/O pin external
pull-down resistor before
and during configuration
12kΩ
Notes to Tab l e 5 4 :
(1) Typical values are for TA = 25°C, VCCINT = 1.2 V, and VCCIO = 1.5 V, 1.8 V, 2.5 V, and 3.3 V.
(2) This value is specified for normal device operation. The value may vary during power-up. This applies for all
VCCIO settings (3.3, 2.5, 1.8, and 1.5 V).
(3) Maximum values depend on the actual TJ and design utilization. See the Excel-based PowerPlay Early Power
Estimator (available at www.altera.com) or the Quartus II PowerPlay Power Analyzer feature for maximum
values. See the section “Power Consumption” on page 5–20 for more information.
(4) Pin pull-up resistance values are lower if an external source drives the pin higher than VCCIO.
Table 5–4. Stratix II Device DC Operating Conditions (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
Table 5–5. LVTTL Specifications (Part 1 of 2)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) Output supply voltage 3.135 3.465 V
VIH High-level input voltage 1.7 4.0 V
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.3 0.8 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –4 mA (2) 2.4 V
Altera Corporation 5–5
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 4 mA (2) 0.45 V
Notes to Tab l e s 5 5 :
(1) Stratix II devices comply to the narrow range for the supply voltage as specified in the EIA/JEDEC Standard,
JESD8-B.
(2) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive strength settings available for this I/O standard
as shown in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–6. LVCMOS Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) Output supply voltage 3.135 3.465 V
VIH High-level input voltage 1.7 4.0 V
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.3 0.8 V
VOH High-level output voltage VCCIO = 3.0,
IOH = –0.1 mA (2)
VCCIO – 0.2 V
VOL Low-level output voltage VCCIO = 3.0,
IOL = 0.1 mA (2)
0.2 V
Notes to Tab l e 5 6 :
(1) Stratix II devices comply to the narrow range for the supply voltage as specified in the EIA/JEDEC Standard,
JESD8-B.
(2) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive strength available for this I/O standard as
shown in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–7. 2.5-V I/O Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) Output supply voltage 2.375 2.625 V
VIH High-level input voltage 1.7 4.0 V
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.3 0.7 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –1mA (2) 2.0 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 1 mA (2) 0.4 V
Notes to Tab l e 5 7 :
(1) Stratix II devices VCCIO voltage level support of 2.5 ± -5% is narrower than defined in the Normal Range of the
EIA/JEDEC standard.
(2) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–5. LVTTL Specifications (Part 2 of 2)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
5–6 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
Figures 5–1 and 5–2 show receiver input and transmitter output
waveforms, respectively, for all differential I/O standards (LVDS,
LVPECL, and HyperTransport technology).
Table 5–8. 1.8-V I/O Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) Output supply voltage 1.71 1.89 V
VIH High-level input voltage 0.65 × VCCIO 2.25 V
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.30 0.35 × VCCIO V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –2 mA (2) VCCIO – 0.45 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 2 mA (2) 0.45 V
Notes to Tab l e 5 8 :
(1) The Stratix II device family’s VCCIO voltage level support of 1.8 ± -5% is narrower than defined in the Normal
Range of the EIA/JEDEC standard.
(2) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–9. 1.5-V I/O Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) Output supply voltage 1.425 1.575 V
VIH High-level input voltage 0.65 × VCCIO VCCIO + 0.30 V
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.30 0.35 × VCCIO V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –2 mA (2) 0.75 × VCCIO V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 2 mA (2) 0.25 × VCCIO V
Notes to Tab l e 5 9 :
(1) The Stratix II device family’s VCCIO voltage level support of 1.5 ± -5% is narrower than defined in the Normal
Range of the EIA/JEDEC standard.
(2) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Altera Corporation 5–7
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Figure 5–1. Receiver Input Waveforms for Differential I/O Standards
Figure 5–2. Transmitter Output Waveforms for Differential I/O Standards
Single-Ended Waveform
Differential Waveform
Positive Channel (p) = V
IH
Negative Channel (n) = V
IL
Ground
V
ID
V
ID
V
ID
p n = 0 V
V
CM
Single-Ended Waveform
Differential Waveform
Positive Channel (p) = V
OH
Negative Channel (n) = V
OL
Ground
V
OD
V
OD
V
OD
p n = 0 V
V
CM
5–8 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
Table 5–10. 2.5-V LVDS I/O Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO I/O supply voltage for left and
right I/O banks (1, 2, 5, and
6)
2.375 2.500 2.625 V
VID Input differential voltage
swing (single-ended)
100 350 900 mV
VICM Input common mode voltage 200 1,250 1,800 mV
VOD Output differential voltage
(single-ended)
RL = 100 Ω250 450 mV
VOCM Output common mode
voltage
RL = 100 Ω1.125 1.375 V
RLReceiver differential input
discrete resistor (external to
Stratix II devices)
90 100 110 Ω
Table 5–11. 3.3-V LVDS I/O Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) I/O supply voltage for top
and bottom PLL banks (9,
10, 11, and 12)
3.135 3.300 3.465 V
VID Input differential voltage
swing (single-ended)
100 350 900 mV
VICM Input common mode voltage 200 1,250 1,800 mV
VOD Output differential voltage
(single-ended)
RL = 100 Ω250 710 mV
VOCM Output common mode
voltage
RL = 100 Ω840 1,570 mV
RLReceiver differential input
discrete resistor (external to
Stratix II devices)
90 100 110 Ω
Note to Table 511:
(1) The top and bottom clock input differential buffers in I/O banks 3, 4, 7, and 8 are powered by VCCINT, not VCCIO.
The PLL clock output/feedback differential buffers are powered by VCC_PLL_OUT. For differential clock
output/feedback operation, VCC_PLL_OUT should be connected to 3.3 V.
Altera Corporation 5–9
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–12. LVPECL Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO (1) I/O supply voltage 3.135 3.300 3.465 V
VID Input differential voltage
swing (single-ended)
300 600 1,000 mV
VICM Input common mode voltage 1.0 2.5 V
VOD Output differential voltage
(single-ended)
RL = 100 Ω525 970 mV
VOCM Output common mode
voltage
RL = 100 Ω1,650 2,250 mV
RLReceiver differential input
resistor
90 100 110 Ω
Note to Table 5–12:
(1) The top and bottom clock input differential buffers in I/O banks 3, 4, 7, and 8 are powered by VCCINT, not VCCIO.
The PLL clock output/feedback differential buffers are powered by VCC_PLL_OUT. For differential clock
output/feedback operation, VCC_PLL_OUT should be connected to 3.3 V.
Table 5–13. HyperTransport Technology Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO I/O supply voltage for left and
right I/O banks (1, 2, 5, and 6)
2.375 2.500 2.625 V
VID Input differential voltage swing
(single-ended)
RL = 100 Ω300 600 900 mV
VICM Input common mode voltage RL = 100 Ω385 600 845 mV
VOD Output differential voltage
(single-ended)
RL = 100 Ω400 600 820 mV
Δ VOD Change in VOD between high
and low
RL = 100 Ω75 mV
VOCM Output common mode voltage RL = 100 Ω440 600 780 mV
Δ VOCM Change in VOCM between high
and low
RL = 100 Ω50 mV
RLReceiver differential input
resistor
90 100 110 Ω
Table 5–14. 3.3-V PCI Specifications (Part 1 of 2)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 3.0 3.3 3.6 V
VIH High-level input voltage 0.5 × VCCIO VCCIO + 0.5 V
5–10 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.3 0.3 × VCCIO V
VOH High-level output voltage IOUT = –500 μA0.9 × VCCIO V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOUT = 1,500 μA0.1 × VCCIO V
Table 5–15. PCI-X Mode 1 Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 3.0 3.6 V
VIH High-level input voltage 0.5 × VCCIO VCCIO + 0.5 V
VIL Low-level input voltage –0.30 0.35 × VCCIO V
VIPU Input pull-up voltage 0.7 × VCCIO V
VOH High-level output voltage IOUT = –500 μA0.9 × VCCIO V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOUT = 1,500 μA0.1 × VCCIO V
Table 5–16. SSTL-18 Class I Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.71 1.80 1.89 V
VREF Reference voltage 0.855 0.900 0.945 V
VTT Termination voltage VREF – 0.04 VREF VREF + 0.04 V
VIH (DC) High-level DC input voltage VREF + 0.125 V
VIL (DC) Low-level DC input voltage VREF – 0.125 V
VIH (AC) High-level AC input voltage VREF + 0.25 V
VIL (AC) Low-level AC input voltage VREF – 0.25 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –6.7 mA (1) VTT + 0.475 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 6.7 mA (1) VTT – 0.475 V
Note to Table 5–16:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–14. 3.3-V PCI Specifications (Part 2 of 2)
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
Altera Corporation 5–11
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–17. SSTL-18 Class II Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.71 1.80 1.89 V
VREF Reference voltage 0.855 0.900 0.945 V
VTT Termination voltage VREF – 0.04 VREF VREF + 0.04 V
VIH (DC) High-level DC input voltage VREF + 0.125 V
VIL (DC) Low-level DC input voltage VREF – 0.125 V
VIH (AC) High-level AC input voltage VREF + 0.25 V
VIL (AC) Low-level AC input voltage VREF – 0.25 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –13.4 mA (1) VCCIO – 0.28 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 13.4 mA (1) 0.28 V
Note to Table 5–17:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–18. SSTL-18 Class I & II Differential Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.71 1.80 1.89 V
VSWING
(DC)
DC differential input voltage 0.25 V
VX (AC) AC differential input cross
point voltage
(VCCIO/2) – 0.175 (VCCIO/2) + 0.175 V
VSWING
(AC)
AC differential input voltage 0.5 V
VISO Input clock signal offset
voltage
0.5 × VCCIO V
ΔVISO Input clock signal offset
voltage variation
±200 mV
VOX
(AC)
AC differential cross point
voltage
(VCCIO/2) – 0.125 (VCCIO/2) + 0.125 V
5–12 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
Table 5–19. SSTL-2 Class I Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 2.375 2.500 2.625 V
VTT Termination voltage VREF – 0.04 VREF VREF + 0.04 V
VREF Reference voltage 1.188 1.250 1.313 V
VIH (DC) High-level DC input voltage VREF + 0.18 3.00 V
VIL (DC) Low-level DC input voltage –0.30 VREF – 0.18 V
VIH (AC) High-level AC input voltage VREF + 0.35 V
VIL (AC) Low-level AC input voltage VREF - 0.35 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –8.1 mA (1) VTT + 0.57 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 8.1 mA (1) VTT – 0.57 V
Note to Table 5–19:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–20. SSTL-2 Class II Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 2.375 2.500 2.625 V
VTT Termination voltage VREF – 0.04 VREF VREF + 0.04 V
VREF Reference voltage 1.188 1.250 1.313 V
VIH (DC) High-level DC input voltage VREF + 0.18 VCCIO + 0.30 V
VIL (DC) Low-level DC input voltage –0.30 VREF – 0.18 V
VIH (AC) High-level AC input voltage VREF + 0.35 V
VIL (AC) Low-level AC input voltage VREF - 0.35 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = –16.4 mA (1) VTT + 0.76 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOL = 16.4 mA (1) VTT – 0.76 V
Note to Table 5–20:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Altera Corporation 5–13
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–21. SSTL-2 Class I & II Differential Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 2.375 2.500 2.625 V
VSWING
(DC)
DC differential input voltage 0.36 V
VX (AC) AC differential input cross
point voltage
(VCCIO/2) – 0.2 (VCCIO/2) + 0.2 V
VSWING
(AC)
AC differential input voltage 0.7 V
VISO Input clock signal offset
voltage
0.5 × VCCIO V
ΔVISO Input clock signal offset
voltage variation
±200 mV
VOX
(AC)
AC differential output cross
point voltage
(VCCIO/2) – 0.2 (VCCIO/2) + 0.2 V
Table 5–22. 1.2-V HSTL Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.14 1.20 1.26 V
VREF Reference voltage 0.48 × VCCIO 0.50 × VCCIO 0.52 × VCCIO V
VIH (DC) High-level DC input voltage VREF + 0.08 VCCIO + 0.15 V
VIL (DC) Low-level DC input voltage –0.15 VREF – 0.08 V
VIH (AC) High-level AC input voltage VREF + 0.15 VCCIO + 0.24 V
VIL (AC) Low-level AC input voltage –0.24 VREF – 0.15 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = 8 mA VREF + 0.15 VCCIO + 0.15 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOH = –8 mA –0.15 VREF – 0.15 V
5–14 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
Table 5–23. 1.5-V HSTL Class I Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.425 1.500 1.575 V
VREF Input reference voltage 0.713 0.750 0.788 V
VTT Termination voltage 0.713 0.750 0.788 V
VIH (DC) DC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.1 V
VIL (DC) DC low-level input voltage –0.3 VREF – 0.1 V
VIH (AC) AC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.2 V
VIL (AC) AC low-level input voltage VREF – 0.2 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = 8 mA (1) VCCIO – 0.4 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOH = –8 mA (1) 0.4 V
Note to Table 5–23:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–24. 1.5-V HSTL Class II Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.425 1.500 1.575 V
VREF Input reference voltage 0.713 0.750 0.788 V
VTT Termination voltage 0.713 0.750 0.788 V
VIH (DC) DC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.1 V
VIL (DC) DC low-level input voltage –0.3 VREF – 0.1 V
VIH (AC) AC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.2 V
VIL (AC) AC low-level input voltage VREF – 0.2 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = 16 mA (1) VCCIO – 0.4 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOH = –16 mA (1) 0.4 V
Note to Table 5–24:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Altera Corporation 5–15
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–25. 1.5-V HSTL Class I & II Differential Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO I/O supply voltage 1.425 1.500 1.575 V
VDIF (DC) DC input differential voltage 0.2 V
VCM (DC) DC common mode input
voltage
0.68 0.90 V
VDIF (AC) AC differential input voltage 0.4 V
VOX (AC) AC differential cross point
voltage
0.68 0.90 V
Table 5–26. 1.8-V HSTL Class I Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.71 1.80 1.89 V
VREF Input reference voltage 0.85 0.90 0.95 V
VTT Termination voltage 0.85 0.90 0.95 V
VIH (DC) DC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.1 V
VIL (DC) DC low-level input voltage –0.3 VREF – 0.1 V
VIH (AC) AC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.2 V
VIL (AC) AC low-level input voltage VREF – 0.2 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = 8 mA (1) VCCIO – 0.4 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOH = –8 mA (1) 0.4 V
Note to Table 5–26:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
5–16 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
Table 5–27. 1.8-V HSTL Class II Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO Output supply voltage 1.71 1.80 1.89 V
VREF Input reference voltage 0.85 0.90 0.95 V
VTT Termination voltage 0.85 0.90 0.95 V
VIH (DC) DC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.1 V
VIL (DC) DC low-level input voltage –0.3 VREF – 0.1 V
VIH (AC) AC high-level input voltage VREF + 0.2 V
VIL (AC) AC low-level input voltage VREF – 0.2 V
VOH High-level output voltage IOH = 16 mA (1) VCCIO – 0.4 V
VOL Low-level output voltage IOH = –16 mA (1) 0.4 V
Note to Table 5–27:
(1) This specification is supported across all the programmable drive settings available for this I/O standard as shown
in the Stratix II Architecture chapter in volume 1 of the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–28. 1.8-V HSTL Class I & II Differential Specifications
Symbol Parameter Conditions Minimum Typical Maximum Unit
VCCIO I/O supply voltage 1.71 1.80 1.89 V
VDIF (DC) DC input differential voltage 0.2 VCCIO + 0.6 V V
VCM (DC) DC common mode input
voltage
0.78 1.12 V
VDIF (AC) AC differential input voltage 0.4 VCCIO + 0.6 V V
VOX (AC) AC differential cross point
voltage
0.68 0.90 V
Altera Corporation 5–17
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Bus Hold Specifications
Table 5–29 shows the Stratix II device family bus hold specifications.
On-Chip Termination Specifications
Tables 5–30 and 5–31 define the specification for internal termination
resistance tolerance when using series or differential on-chip termination.
Table 5–29. Bus Hold Parameters
Parameter Conditions
VCCIO Level
Unit
1.2 V 1.5 V 1.8 V 2.5 V 3.3 V
Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max Min Max
Low
sustaining
current
VIN > VIL
(maximum)
22.5 25.0 30.0 50.0 70.0 μA
High
sustaining
current
VIN < VIH
(minimum)
–22.5 –25.0 –30.0 –50.0 –70.0 μA
Low
overdrive
current
0 V < VIN <
VCCIO
120 160 200 300 500 μA
High
overdrive
current
0 V < VIN <
VCCIO
–120 –160 –200 –300 –500 μA
Bus-hold
trip point
0.45 0.95 0.50 1.00 0.68 1.07 0.70 1.70 0.80 2.00 V
Table 5–30. Series On-Chip Termination Specification for Top & Bottom I/O Banks (Part 1 of 2)
Notes (1), 2
Symbol Description Conditions
Resistance Tolerance
Commercial
Max
Industrial
Max Unit
25-Ω RS
3.3/2.5
Internal series termination with
calibration (25-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 3.3/2.5 V ±5 ±10 %
Internal series termination without
calibration (25-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 3.3/2.5 V ±30 ±30 %
5–18 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Operating Conditions
50-Ω RS
3.3/2.5
Internal series termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 3.3/2.5 V ±5 ±10 %
Internal series termination without
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 3.3/2.5 V ±30 ±30 %
50-Ω RT
2.5
Internal parallel termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.8 V ±30 ±30 %
25-Ω RS
1.8
Internal series termination with
calibration (25-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.8 V ±5 ±10 %
Internal series termination without
calibration (25-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.8 V ±30 ±30 %
50-Ω RS
1.8
Internal series termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.8 V ±5 ±10 %
Internal series termination without
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.8 V ±30 ±30 %
50-Ω RT
1.8
Internal parallel termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.8 V ±10 ±15 %
50−Ω RS
1.5
Internal series termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.5 V ±8 ±10 %
Internal series termination without
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.5 V ±36 ±36 %
50-Ω RT
1.5
Internal parallel termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.5 V ±10 ±15 %
50−Ω RS
1.2
Internal series termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.2 V ±8 ±10 %
Internal series termination without
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.2 V ±50 ±50 %
50-Ω RT
1.2
Internal parallel termination with
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.2 V ±10 ±15 %
Notes for Table 53 0 :
(1) The resistance tolerances for calibrated SOCT and POCT are for the moment of calibration. If the temperature or
voltage changes over time, the tolerance may also change.
(2) On-chip parallel termination with calibration is only supported for input pins.
Table 5–30. Series On-Chip Termination Specification for Top & Bottom I/O Banks (Part 2 of 2)
Notes (1), 2
Symbol Description Conditions
Resistance Tolerance
Commercial
Max
Industrial
Max Unit
Altera Corporation 5–19
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Pin Capacitance
Table 5–32 shows the Stratix II device family pin capacitance.
Table 5–31. Series & Differential On-Chip Termination Specification for Left & Right I/O Banks
Symbol Description Conditions
Resistance Tolerance
Commercial
Max
Industrial
Max Unit
25-Ω RS
3.3/2.5
Internal series termination without
calibration (25-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 3.3/2.5 V ±30 ±30 %
50-Ω RS
3.3/2.5/1.8
Internal series termination without
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 3.3/2.5/1.8 V ±30 ±30 %
50-Ω RS 1.5 Internal series termination without
calibration (50-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 1.5 V ±36 ±36 %
RDInternal differential termination for
LVDS or HyperTransport technology
(100-Ω setting)
VCCIO = 2.5 V ±20 ±25 %
Table 5–32. Stratix II Device Capacitance Note (1)
Symbol Parameter Typical Unit
CIOTB Input capacitance on I/O pins in I/O banks 3, 4, 7, and 8. 5.0 pF
CIOLR Input capacitance on I/O pins in I/O banks 1, 2, 5, and 6, including high-
speed differential receiver and transmitter pins.
6.1 pF
CCLKTB Input capacitance on top/bottom clock input pins: CLK[4..7] and
CLK[12..15].
6.0 pF
CCLKLR Input capacitance on left/right clock inputs: CLK0, CLK2, CLK8, CLK10.6.1 pF
CCLKLR+ Input capacitance on left/right clock inputs: CLK1, CLK3, CLK9, and
CLK11.
3.3 pF
COUTFB Input capacitance on dual-purpose clock output/feedback pins in PLL
banks 9, 10, 11, and 12.
6.7 pF
Note to Table 5–32:
(1) Capacitance is sample-tested only. Capacitance is measured using time-domain reflections (TDR). Measurement
accuracy is within ±0.5pF
5–20 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Power Consumption
Power
Consumption
Altera® offers two ways to calculate power for a design: the Excel-based
PowerPlay Early Power Estimator power calculator and the Quartus®II
PowerPlay Power Analyzer feature.
The interactive Excel-based PowerPlay Early Power Estimator is typically
used prior to designing the FPGA in order to get an estimate of device
power. The Quartus II PowerPlay Power Analyzer provides better
quality estimates based on the specifics of the design after place-and-
route is complete. The Power Analyzer can apply a combination of user-
entered, simulation-derived and estimated signal activities which,
combined with detailed circuit models, can yield very accurate power
estimates.
In both cases, these calculations should only be used as an estimation of
power, not as a specification.
fFor more information about PowerPlay tools, refer to the PowerPlay Early
Power Estimator User Guide and the PowerPlay Early Power Estimator and
PowerPlay Power Analyzer chapters in volume 3 of the Quartus II
Handbook.
The PowerPlay Early Power Estimator is available on the Altera web site
at www.altera.com. See Table 5–4 on page 5–3 for typical ICC standby
specifications.
Timing Model The DirectDriveTM technology and MultiTrackTM interconnect ensure
predictable performance, accurate simulation, and accurate timing
analysis across all Stratix II device densities and speed grades. This
section describes and specifies the performance, internal timing, external
timing, and PLL, high-speed I/O, external memory interface, and JTAG
timing specifications.
All specifications are representative of worst-case supply voltage and
junction temperature conditions.
1The timing numbers listed in the tables of this section are
extracted from the Quartus II software version 5.0 SP1.
Preliminary & Final Timing
Timing models can have either preliminary or final status. The Quartus II
software issues an informational message during the design compilation
if the timing models are preliminary. Table 5–33 shows the status of the
Stratix II device timing models.
Altera Corporation 5–21
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Preliminary status means the timing model is subject to change. Initially,
timing numbers are created using simulation results, process data, and
other known parameters. These tests are used to make the preliminary
numbers as close to the actual timing parameters as possible.
Final timing numbers are based on actual device operation and testing.
These numbers reflect the actual performance of the device under
worst-case voltage and junction temperature conditions.
I/O Timing Measurement Methodology
Altera characterizes timing delays at the worst-case process, minimum
voltage, and maximum temperature for input register setup time (tSU)
and hold time (tH). The Quartus II software uses the following equations
to calculate tSU and tH timing for Stratix II devices input signals.
tSU = + data delay from input pin to input register
+ micro setup time of the input register
– clock delay from input pin to input register
tH = – data delay from input pin to input register
+ micro hold time of the input register
+ clock delay from input pin to input register
Figure 5–3 shows the setup and hold timing diagram for input registers.
Table 5–33. Stratix II Device Timing Model Status
Device Preliminary Final
EP2S15 v
EP2S30 v
EP2S60 v
EP2S90 v
EP2S130 v
EP2S180 v
5–22 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Figure 5–3. Input Register Setup & Hold Timing Diagram
For output timing, different I/O standards require different baseline
loading techniques for reporting timing delays. Altera characterizes
timing delays with the required termination for each I/O standard and
with 0 pF (except for PCI and PCI-X which use 10 pF) loading and the
timing is specified up to the output pin of the FPGA device. The
Quartus II software calculates the I/O timing for each I/O standard with
a default baseline loading as specified by the I/O standards.
The following measurements are made during device characterization.
Altera measures clock-to-output delays (tCO) at worst-case process,
minimum voltage, and maximum temperature (PVT) for default loading
conditions shown in Table 5–34. Use the following equations to calculate
clock pin to output pin timing for Stratix II devices.
tCO from clock pin to I/O pin = delay from clock pad to I/O output
register + IOE output register clock-to-output delay + delay from
output register to output pin + I/O output delay
txz/tzx from clock pin to I/O pin = delay from clock pad to I/O
output register + IOE output register clock-to-output delay + delay
from output register to output pin + I/O output delay + output
enable pin delay
Simulation using IBIS models is required to determine the delays on the
PCB traces in addition to the output pin delay timing reported by the
Quartus II software and the timing model in the device handbook.
1. Simulate the output driver of choice into the generalized test setup,
using values from Table 5–34.
2. Record the time to VMEAS.
3. Simulate the output driver of choice into the actual PCB trace and
load, using the appropriate IBIS model or capacitance value to
represent the load.
Input Data Delay
Input Clock Delay
micro t
SU
micro t
H
Altera Corporation 5–23
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
4. Record the time to VMEAS.
5. Compare the results of steps 2 and 4. The increase or decrease in
delay should be added to or subtracted from the I/O Standard
Output Adder delays to yield the actual worst-case propagation
delay (clock-to-output) of the PCB trace.
The Quartus II software reports the timing with the conditions shown in
Table 5–34 using the above equation. Figure 5–4 shows the model of the
circuit that is represented by the output timing of the Quartus II software.
Figure 5–4. Output Delay Timing Reporting Setup Modeled by Quartus II
Notes to Figure 5–4:
(1) Output pin timing is reported at the output pin of the FPGA device. Additional
delays for loading and board trace delay need to be accounted for with IBIS model
simulations.
(2) VCCPD is 3.085 V unless otherwise specified.
(3) VCCINT is 1.12 V unless otherwise specified.
Figures 5–5 and 5–6 show the measurement setup for output disable and
output enable timing.
Output
Buffer
V
TT
V
CCIO
R
D
Output
n
Output
p
R
T
C
L
R
S
V
MEAS
Output
GND GND
5–24 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Table 5–34. Output Timing Measurement Methodology for Output Pins Notes (1), (2), (3)
I/O Standard
Loading and Termination Measurement
Point
RS (Ω)R
D (Ω)R
T (Ω)V
CCIO (V) VTT (V) CL (pF) VMEAS (V)
LVT TL (4) 3.135 0 1.5675
LVCMOS (4) 3.135 0 1.5675
2.5 V (4) 2.375 0 1.1875
1.8 V (4) 1.710 0 0.855
1.5 V (4) 1.425 0 0.7125
PCI (5) 2.970 10 1.485
PCI-X (5) 2.970 10 1.485
SSTL-2 Class I 25 50 2.325 1.123 0 1.1625
SSTL-2 Class II 25 25 2.325 1.123 0 1.1625
SSTL-18 Class I 25 50 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
SSTL-18 Class II 25 25 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
1.8-V HSTL Class I 50 50 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
1.8-V HSTL Class II 25 25 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
1.5-V HSTL Class I 50 50 1.375 0.648 0 0.6875
1.5-V HSTL Class II 25 1.375 0.648 0 0.6875
1.2-V HSTL with OCT 50 1.140 0 0.570
Differential SSTL-2 Class I 50 50 2.325 1.123 0 1.1625
Differential SSTL-2 Class II 25 25 2.325 1.123 0 1.1625
Differential SSTL-18 Class I 50 50 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
Differential SSTL-18 Class II 25 25 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
1.5-V Differential HSTL Class I 50 50 1.375 0.648 0 0.6875
1.5-V Differential HSTL Class II 25 1.375 0.648 0 0.6875
1.8-V Differential HSTL Class I 50 50 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
1.8-V Differential HSTL Class II 25 25 1.660 0.790 0 0.83
LVDS 100 2.325 0 1.1625
HyperTransport 100 2.325 0 1.1625
LVPECL 100 3.135 0 1.5675
Notes to Table 5–34:
(1) Input measurement point at internal node is 0.5 × VCCINT
.
(2) Output measuring point for VMEAS at buffer output is 0.5 × VCCIO.
(3) Input stimulus edge rate is 0 to VCC in 0.2 ns (internal signal) from the driver preceding the I/O buffer.
(4) Less than 50-mV ripple on VCCIO and VCCPD, VCCINT = 1.15 V with less than 30-mV ripple
(5) VCCPD = 2.97 V, less than 50-mV ripple on VCCIO and VCCPD, VCCINT = 1.15 V
Altera Corporation 5–25
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Figure 5–5. Measurement Setup for txz Note (1)
Note to Figure 5–5:
(1) VCCINT is 1.12 V for this measurement.
t
XZ
, Driving High to Tristate
t
XZ
, Driving Low to Tristate
100 Ω
Din
OE
Dout
V
CCIO
OE
Enable Disable
Dout
Din
t
lz
100 mv
½ V
CCINT
“0”
100 Ω
Din
OE
Dout OE
Enable Disable
Dout
Din
t
hz
100 mv
½ V
CCINT
“1”
GND
5–26 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Figure 5–6. Measurement Setup for tzx
Table 5–35 specifies the input timing measurement setup.
t
ZX
, Tristate to Driving High
t
ZX
, Tristate to Driving Low
1 MΩ
Din
OE
Dout
1 MΩ
Din
OE
Dout OE
Disable Enable
Dout
Din
t
zh
½ V
CCINT
“1”
½ V
CCI
O
OE
Disable Enable
Dout
Din
½ V
CCINT
“0”
t
zl
½ V
CCI
O
Table 5–35. Timing Measurement Methodology for Input Pins (Part 1 of 2) Notes (1)(4)
I/O Standard
Measurement Conditions Measurement Point
VCCIO (V) VREF (V) Edge Rate (ns) VMEAS (V)
LVT TL (5) 3.135 3.135 1.5675
LVCMOS (5) 3.135 3.135 1.5675
2.5 V (5) 2.375 2.375 1.1875
1.8 V (5) 1.710 1.710 0.855
1.5 V (5) 1.425 1.425 0.7125
PCI (6) 2.970 2.970 1.485
PCI-X (6) 2.970 2.970 1.485
SSTL-2 Class I 2.325 1.163 2.325 1.1625
SSTL-2 Class II 2.325 1.163 2.325 1.1625
SSTL-18 Class I 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
SSTL-18 Class II 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
1.8-V HSTL Class I 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
Altera Corporation 5–27
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Performance
Table 5–36 shows Stratix II performance for some common designs. All
performance values were obtained with the Quartus II software
compilation of library of parameterized modules (LPM), or MegaCore®
functions for the finite impulse response (FIR) and fast Fourier transform
(FFT) designs.
1.8-V HSTL Class II 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
1.5-V HSTL Class I 1.375 0.688 1.375 0.6875
1.5-V HSTL Class II 1.375 0.688 1.375 0.6875
1.2-V HSTL with OCT 1.140 0.570 1.140 0.570
Differential SSTL-2 Class I 2.325 1.163 2.325 1.1625
Differential SSTL-2 Class II 2.325 1.163 2.325 1.1625
Differential SSTL-18 Class I 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
Differential SSTL-18 Class II 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
1.5-V Differential HSTL Class I 1.375 0.688 1.375 0.6875
1.5-V Differential HSTL Class II 1.375 0.688 1.375 0.6875
1.8-V Differential HSTL Class I 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
1.8-V Differential HSTL Class II 1.660 0.830 1.660 0.83
LVDS 2.325 0.100 1.1625
HyperTransport 2.325 0.400 1.1625
LVPECL 3.135 0.100 1.5675
Notes to Table 5–35:
(1) Input buffer sees no load at buffer input.
(2) Input measuring point at buffer input is 0.5 × VCCIO.
(3) Output measuring point is 0.5 × VCC at internal node.
(4) Input edge rate is 1 V/ns.
(5) Less than 50-mV ripple on VCCIO and VCCPD, VCCINT = 1.15 V with less than 30-mV ripple
(6) VCCPD = 2.97 V, less than 50-mV ripple on VCCIO and VCCPD, VCCINT = 1.15 V
Table 5–35. Timing Measurement Methodology for Input Pins (Part 2 of 2) Notes (1)(4)
I/O Standard
Measurement Conditions Measurement Point
VCCIO (V) VREF (V) Edge Rate (ns) VMEAS (V)
5–28 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
1The performance numbers in Table 5–36 are extracted from the
Quartus II software version 5.1 SP1.
Table 5–36. Stratix II Performance Notes (Part 1 of 6) Note (1)
Applications
Resources Used Performance
ALUTs
TriMatrix
Memory
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
-3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
LE 16-to-1 multiplexer (4) 21 0 0 654.87 625.0 523.83 460.4 MHz
32-to-1 multiplexer (4) 38 0 0 519.21 473.26 464.25 384.17 MHz
16-bit counter 16 0 0 566.57 538.79 489.23 421.05 MHz
64-bit counter 64 0 0 244.31 232.07 209.11 181.38 MHz
Tr iMa tr i x
Memory
M512
block
Simple dual-port RAM
32 × 18 bit
0 1 0 500.00 476.19 434.02 373.13 MHz
FIFO 32 x 18 bit 22 1 0 500.00 476.19 434.78 373.13 MHz
Tr iMa tr i x
Memory
M4K
block
Simple dual-port RAM
128 x 36 bit (8)
0 1 0 540.54 515.46 469.48 401.60 MHz
True dual-port RAM
128 × 18 bit (8)
0 1 0 540.54 515.46 469.48 401.60 MHz
FIFO
128 × 36 bit
22 1 0 530.22 499.00 469.48 401.60 MHz
Simple dual-port RAM
128 × 36 bit (9)
0 1 0 475.28 453.30 413.22 354.10 MHz
True dual-port RAM
128 × 18 bit (9)
0 1 0 475.28 453.30 413.22 354.10 MHz
Altera Corporation 5–29
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Tr iMa tr i x
Memory
M-RAM
block
Single port
RAM 4K × 144 bit
0 1 0 349.65 333.33 303.95 261.09 MHz
Simple dual-port
RAM 4K × 144 bit
0 1 0 420.16 400.00 364.96 313.47 MHz
True dual-port
RAM 4K × 144 bit
0 1 0 349.65 333.33 303.95 261.09 MHz
Single port
RAM 8K × 72 bit
0 1 0 354.60 337.83 307.69 263.85 MHz
Simple dual-port
RAM 8K × 72 bit
0 1 0 420.16 400.00 364.96 313.47 MHz
True dual-port
RAM 8K × 72 bit
0 1 0 349.65 333.33 303.95 261.09 MHz
Single port
RAM 16K × 36 bit
0 1 0 364.96 347.22 317.46 271.73 MHz
Simple dual-port
RAM 16K × 36 bit
0 1 0 420.16 400.00 364.96 313.47 MHz
True dual-port
RAM 16K × 36 bit
0 1 0 359.71 342.46 313.47 268.09 MHz
Single port
RAM 32K × 18 bit
0 1 0 364.96 347.22 317.46 271.73 MHz
Simple dual-port
RAM 32K × 18 bit
0 1 0 420.16 400.0 364.96 313.47 MHz
True dual-port
RAM 32K × 18 bit
0 1 0 359.71 342.46 313.47 268.09 MHz
Single port
RAM 64K × 9 bit
0 1 0 364.96 347.22 317.46 271.73 MHz
Simple dual-port
RAM 64K × 9 bit
0 1 0 420.16 400.0 364.96 313.47 MHz
True dual-port
RAM 64K × 9 bit
0 1 0 359.71 342.46 313.47 268.09 MHz
Table 5–36. Stratix II Performance Notes (Part 2 of 6) Note (1)
Applications
Resources Used Performance
ALUTs
TriMatrix
Memory
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
-3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
5–30 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
DSP
block
9 × 9-bit multiplier (5) 0 0 1 430.29 409.16 373.13 320.10 MHz
18 × 18-bit
multiplier (5)
0 0 1 410.17 390.01 356.12 305.06 MHz
18 × 18-bit
multiplier (7)
0 0 1 450.04 428.08 391.23 335.12 MHz
36 × 36-bit
multiplier (5)
0 0 1 250.00 238.15 217.48 186.60 MHz
36 × 36-bit multiplier
(6)
0 0 1 410.17 390.01 356.12 305.06 MHz
18-bit, four-tap FIR
filter
0 0 1 410.17 390.01 356.12 305.06 MHz
Larger
designs
8-bit,16-tap parallel
FIR filter
58 0 4 259.06 240.61 217.15 185.01 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
streaming, three
multipliers and five
adders FFT function
2976 22 9 398.72 364.03 355.23 306.37 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
streaming, four
multipliers and two
adders FFT function
2781 22 12 398.56 409.16 347.22 311.13 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
single output, one
parallel FFT engine,
burst, three multipliers
and five adders FFT
function
984 5 3 425.17 365.76 346.98 292.39 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
single output, one
parallel FFT engine,
burst, four multipliers
and two adders FFT
function
919 5 4 427.53 378.78 357.14 307.59 MHz
Table 5–36. Stratix II Performance Notes (Part 3 of 6) Note (1)
Applications
Resources Used Performance
ALUTs
TriMatrix
Memory
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
-3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Altera Corporation 5–31
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Larger
designs
8-bit, 1024-point,
single output, two
parallel FFT engines,
burst, three multiplier
and five adders FFT
function
1725 10 6 430.29 401.92 373.13 319.08 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
single output, two
parallel FFT engines,
burst, four multipliers
and two adders FFT
function
1594 10 8 422.65 407.33 373.13 329.10 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, one
parallel FFT engine,
burst, three multipliers
and five adders FFT
function
2361 10 9 315.45 342.81 325.73 284.25 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, one
parallel FFT engine,
burst, four multipliers
and two adders FFT
function
2165 10 12 373.13 369.54 317.96 256.14 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, two
parallel FFT engines,
burst, three multipliers
and five adders FFT
function
3996 14 18 378.50 367.10 332.33 288.68 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, two
parallel FFT engines,
burst, four multipliers
and two adders FFT
function
3604 14 24 391.38 361.14 340.25 280.89 MHz
Table 5–36. Stratix II Performance Notes (Part 4 of 6) Note (1)
Applications
Resources Used Performance
ALUTs
TriMatrix
Memory
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
-3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
5–32 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Larger
designs
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, four
parallel FFT engines,
burst, three multipliers
and five adders FFT
function
6850 28 36 334.11 345.66 308.54 276.31 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, four
parallel FFT engines,
burst, four multipliers
two adders FFT
function
6067 28 48 367.91 349.04 327.33 268.24 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, one
parallel FFT engine,
buffered burst, three
multipliers and adders
FFT function
2730 18 9 387.44 388.34 364.56 306.84 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, one
parallel FFT engine,
buffered burst, four
multipliers and two
adders FFT function
2534 18 12 419.28 369.66 364.96 307.88 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, two
parallel FFT engines,
buffered burst, three
multipliers five adders
FFT function
4358 30 18 396.51 378.07 340.13 291.29 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, two
parallel FFT engines,
buffered burst four
multipliers and two
adders FFT function
3966 30 24 389.71 398.08 356.53 280.74 MHz
Table 5–36. Stratix II Performance Notes (Part 5 of 6) Note (1)
Applications
Resources Used Performance
ALUTs
TriMatrix
Memory
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
-3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Altera Corporation 5–33
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Larger
designs
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, four
parallel FFT engines,
buffered burst, three
multipliers five adders
FFT function
7385 60 36 359.58 352.98 312.01 278.00 MHz
8-bit, 1024-point,
quadrant output, four
parallel FFT engines,
buffered burst, four
multipliers and two
adders FFT function
6601 60 48 371.88 355.74 327.86 277.62 MHz
Notes for Table 53 6 :
(1) These design performance numbers were obtained using the Quartus II software version 5.0 SP1.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(4) This application uses registered inputs and outputs.
(5) This application uses registered multiplier input and output stages within the DSP block.
(6) This application uses registered multiplier input, pipeline, and output stages within the DSP block.
(7) This application uses registered multiplier input with output of the multiplier stage feeding the accumulator or
subtractor within the DSP block.
(8) This application uses the same clock source that is globally routed and connected to ports A and B.
(9) This application uses locally routed clocks or differently sourced clocks for ports A and B.
Table 5–36. Stratix II Performance Notes (Part 6 of 6) Note (1)
Applications
Resources Used Performance
ALUTs
TriMatrix
Memory
Blocks
DSP
Blocks
-3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
5–34 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Internal Timing Parameters
See Tables 5–37 through 5–42 for internal timing parameters.
Table 5–37. LE_FF Internal Timing Microparameters
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (1)
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(3) Max Min
(3) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(3) Max
tSU LE register setup time before
clock
90 95 104
104
121 ps
tH LE register hold time after clock 149 157 172
172
200 ps
tCO LE register clock-to-output
delay
62 94 62 99 59
62
109 62 127 ps
tCLR Minimum clear pulse width 204 214 234
234
273 ps
tPRE Minimum preset pulse width 204 214 234
234
273 ps
tCLKL Minimum clock low time 612 642 703
703
820 ps
tCLKH Minimum clock high time 612 642 703
703
820 ps
tLUT 162 378 162 397 162
170
435 162 507 ps
tADDER 354 619 354 650 354
372
712 354 829 ps
Notes to Table 5–37:
(1) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(3) For the -3 and -5 speed grades, the minimum timing is for the commercial temperature grade. Only -4 speed grade
devices offer the industrial temperature grade.
(4) For the -4 speed grade, the first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second
number is the minimum timing parameter for commercial devices.
Altera Corporation 5–35
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–38. IOE Internal Timing Microparameters
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (1)
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(3) Max Min
(3) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(3) Max
tSU IOE input and output
register setup time
before clock
122 128 140
140
163 ps
tH IOE input and output
register hold time after
clock
72 75 82
82
96 ps
tCO IOE input and output
register clock-to-
output delay
101 169 101 177 97
101
194 101 226 ps
tPIN2COMBOUT_R Row input pin to IOE
combinational output
410 760 410 798 391
410
873 410 1,018 ps
tPIN2COMBOUT_C Column input pin to
IOE combinational
output
428 787 428 825 408
428
904 428 1,054 ps
tCOMBIN2PIN_R Row IOE data input to
combinational output
pin
1,101 2,026 1,101 2,127 1,049
1,101
2,329 1,101 2,439 ps
tCOMBIN2PIN_C Column IOE data
input to combinational
output pin
991 1,854 991 1,946 944
991
2,131 991 2,246 ps
tCLR Minimum clear pulse
width
200 210 229
229
268 ps
tPRE Minimum preset pulse
width
200 210 229
229
268 ps
tCLKL Minimum clock low
time
600 630 690
690
804 ps
tCLKH Minimum clock high
time
600 630 690
690
804 ps
Notes to Table 5–38:
(1) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(3) For the -3 and -5 speed grades, the minimum timing is for the commercial temperature grade. Only -4 speed grade
devices offer the industrial temperature grade.
(4) For the -4 speed grade, the first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second
number is the minimum timing parameter for commercial devices.
5–36 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Table 5–39. DSP Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 1 of 2)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (1)
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(3) Max Min
(3) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(3) Max
tSU Input, pipeline, and
output register setup
time before clock
50 52 57
57
67 ps
tH Input, pipeline, and
output register hold
time after clock
180 189 206
206
241 ps
tCO Input, pipeline, and
output register clock-
to-output delay
00 00 0
0
0 0 0 ps
tINREG2PIPE9 Input register to DSP
block pipeline register
in 9 × 9-bit mode
1,312 2,030 1,312 2,030 1,250
1,312
2,334 1,312 2,720 ps
tINREG2PIPE18 Input register to DSP
block pipeline register
in 18 × 18-bit mode
1,302 2,010 1,302 2,110 1,240
1,302
2,311 1,302 2,693 ps
tINREG2PIPE36 Input register to DSP
block pipeline register
in 36 × 36-bit mode
1,302 2,010 1,302 2,110 1,240
1,302
2,311 1,302 2,693 ps
tPIPE2OUTREG2ADD DSP block pipeline
register to output
register delay in two-
multipliers adder
mode
924 1,450 924 1,522 880
924
1,667 924 1,943 ps
tPIPE2OUTREG4ADD DSP block pipeline
register to output
register delay in four-
multipliers adder
mode
1,134 1,850 1,134 1,942 1,080
1,134
2,127 1,134 2,479 ps
tPD9 Combinational input
to output delay for
9×9
2,100 2,880 2,100 3,024 2,000
2,100
3,312 2,100 3,859 ps
tPD18 Combinational input
to output delay for
18 × 18
2,110 2,990 2,110 3,139 2,010
2,110
3,438 2,110 4,006 ps
tPD36 Combinational input
to output delay for
36 × 36
2,939 4,450 2,939 4,672 2,800
2,939
5,117 2,939 5,962 ps
tCLR Minimum clear pulse
width
2,212 2,322 2,543
2,543
2,964 ps
Altera Corporation 5–37
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
tCLKL Minimum clock low
time
1,190 1,249 1,368
1,368
1,594 ps
tCLKH Minimum clock high
time
1,190 1,249 1,368
1,368
1,594 ps
Notes to Table 5–39:
(1) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(3) For the -3 and -5 speed grades, the minimum timing is for the commercial temperature grade. Only -4 speed grade
devices offer the industrial temperature grade.
(4) For the -4 speed grade, the first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second
number is the minimum timing parameter for commercial devices.
Table 5–40. M512 Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(4) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(5) Max Min
(4) Max
tM512RC Synchronous read cycle
time
2,089 2,318 2,089 2.433 1,989
2,089
2,664 2,089 3,104 ps
tM512WERESU Write or read enable
setup time before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM512WEREH Write or read enable
hold time after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM512DATASU Data setup time before
clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM512DATAH Data hold time after
clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM512WADDRSU Write address setup
time before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM512WADDRH Write address hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM512RADDRSU Read address setup
time before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM512RADDRH Read address hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
Table 5–39. DSP Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 2 of 2)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (1)
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(3) Max Min
(3) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(3) Max
5–38 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
tM512DATACO1 Clock-to-output delay
when using output
registers
298 478 298 501 284
298
548 298 640 ps
tM512DATACO2 Clock-to-output delay
without output registers
2,102 2,345 2,102 2,461 2,003
2,102
2,695 2,102 3,141 ps
tM512CLKL Minimum clock low time 1,315 1,380 1,512
1,512
1,762 ps
tM512CLKH Minimum clock high time 1,315 1,380 1,512
1,512
1,762 ps
tM512CLR Minimum clear pulse
width
144 151 165
165
192 ps
Notes to Table 5–40:
(1) FMAX of M512 block obtained using the Quartus II software does not necessarily equal to 1/TM512RC.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(4) For the -3 and -5 speed grades, the minimum timing is for the commercial temperature grade. Only -4 speed grade
devices offer the industrial temperature grade.
(5) For the -4 speed grade, the first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second
number is the minimum timing parameter for commercial devices.
Table 5–41. M4K Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(4) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(5) Max Min
(4) Max
tM4KRC Synchronous read cycle
time
1,462 2,240 1,462 2,351 1,393
1,462
2,575 1,462 3,000 ps
tM4KWERESU Write or read enable
setup time before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM4KWEREH Write or read enable
hold time after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM4KBESU Byte enable setup time
before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM4KBEH Byte enable hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
Table 5–40. M512 Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(4) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(5) Max Min
(4) Max
Altera Corporation 5–39
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
tM4KDATAASU A port data setup time
before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM4KDATAAH A port data hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM4KADDRASU A port address setup
time before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM4KADDRAH A port address hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM4KDATABSU B port data setup time
before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM4KDATABH B port data hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM4KRADDRBSU B port address setup
time before clock
22 23 25
25
29 ps
tM4KRADDRBH B port address hold time
after clock
203 213 233
233
272 ps
tM4KDATACO1 Clock-to-output delay
when using output
registers
334 524 334 549 319
334
601 334 701 ps
tM4KDATACO2
(6)
Clock-to-output delay
without output registers
1,616 2,453 1,616 2,574 1,540
1,616
2,820 1,616 3,286 ps
tM4KCLKH Minimum clock high time 1,250 1,312 1,437
1,437
1,675 ps
tM4KCLKL Minimum clock low time 1,250 1,312 1,437
1,437
1,675 ps
tM4KCLR Minimum clear pulse
width
144 151 165
165
192 ps
Notes to Table 5–41:
(1) FMAX of M4K Block obtained using the Quartus II software does not necessarily equal to 1/TM4KRC.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(4) For the -3 and -5 speed grades, the minimum timing is for the commercial temperature grade. Only -4 speed grade
devices offer the industrial temperature grade.
(5) For the -4 speed grade, the first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second
number is the minimum timing parameter for commercial devices.
(6) Numbers apply to unpacked memory modes, true dual-port memory modes, and simple dual-port memory modes
that use locally routed or non-identical sources for the A and B port registers.
Table 5–41. M4K Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(4) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(5) Max Min
(4) Max
5–40 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Table 5–42. M-RAM Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(4) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(5) Max Min
(4) Max
tMEGARC Synchronous read cycle
time
1,866 2,774 1,866 2,911 1,777
1,866
3,189 1,777
1,866
3,716 ps
tMEGAWERESU Write or read enable
setup time before clock
144 151 165
165
192 ps
tMEGAWEREH Write or read enable
hold time after clock
39 40 44
44
52 ps
tMEGABESU Byte enable setup time
before clock
50 52 57
57
67 ps
tMEGABEH Byte enable hold time
after clock
39 40 44
44
52 ps
tMEGADATAASU A port data setup time
before clock
50 52 57
57
67 ps
tMEGADATAAH A port data hold time
after clock
243 255 279
279
325 ps
tMEGAADDRASU A port address setup
time before clock
589 618 677
677
789 ps
tMEGAADDRAH A port address hold time
after clock
241 253 277
277
322 ps
tMEGADATABSU B port setup time before
clock
50 52 57
57
67 ps
tMEGADATABH B port hold time after
clock
243 255 279
279
325 ps
tMEGAADDRBSU B port address setup
time before clock
589 618 677
677
789 ps
tMEGAADDRBH B port address hold time
after clock
241 253 277
277
322 ps
tMEGADATACO1 Clock-to-output delay
when using output
registers
480 715 480 749 457
480
821 480 957 ps
tMEGADATACO2 Clock-to-output delay
without output registers
1,950 2,899 1,950 3,042 1,857
1,950
3,332 1,950 3,884 ps
tMEGACLKL Minimum clock low time 1,250 1,312 1,437
1,437
1,675 ps
Altera Corporation 5–41
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Stratix II Clock Timing Parameters
See Tables 5–43 through 5–67 for Stratix II clock timing parameters.
tMEGACLKH Minimum clock high
time
1,250 1,312 1,437
1,437
1,675 ps
tMEGACLR Minimum clear pulse
width
144 151 165
165
192 ps
Notes to Table 5–42:
(1) FMAX of M-RAM Block obtained using the Quartus II software does not necessarily equal to 1/TMEGARC.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
(4) For the -3 and -5 speed grades, the minimum timing is for the commercial temperature grade. Only -4 speed grade
devices offer the industrial temperature grade.
(5) For the -4 speed grade, the first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second
number is the minimum timing parameter for commercial devices.
Table 5–42. M-RAM Block Internal Timing Microparameters (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Symbol Parameter
-3 Speed
Grade (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Min
(4) Max Min
(4) Max Min
(5) Max Min
(4) Max
Table 5–43. Stratix II Clock Timing Parameters
Symbol Parameter
tCIN Delay from clock pad to I/O input register
tCOUT Delay from clock pad to I/O output register
tPLLCIN Delay from PLL inclk pad to I/O input register
tPLLCOUT Delay from PLL inclk pad to I/O output register
5–42 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
EP2S15 Clock Timing Parameters
Tables 5–44 though 5–47 show the maximum clock timing parameters for
EP2S15 devices.
Table 5–44. EP2S15 Column Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.445 1.512 2.487 2.848 3.309 ns
tCOUT 1.288 1.347 2.245 2.570 2.985 ns
tPLLCIN 0.104 0.102 0.336 0.373 0.424 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.053 -0.063 0.094 0.095 0.1 ns
Table 5–45. EP2S15 Column Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.419 1.487 2.456 2.813 3.273 ns
tCOUT 1.262 1.322 2.214 2.535 2.949 ns
tPLLCIN 0.094 0.092 0.326 0.363 0.414 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.063 -0.073 0.084 0.085 0.09 ns
Table 5–46. EP2S15 Row Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.232 1.288 2.144 2.454 2.848 ns
tCOUT 1.237 1.293 2.140 2.450 2.843 ns
tPLLCIN -0.109 -0.122 -0.007 -0.021 -0.037 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.104 -0.117 -0.011 -0.025 -0.042 ns
Altera Corporation 5–43
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
EP2S30 Clock Timing Parameters
Tables 5–48 through 5–51 show the maximum clock timing parameters
for EP2S30 devices.
Table 5–47. EP2S15 Row Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.206 1.262 2.113 2.422 2.815 ns
tCOUT 1.211 1.267 2.109 2.418 2.810 ns
tPLLCIN -0.125 -0.138 -0.023 -0.038 -0.056 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.12 -0.133 -0.027 -0.042 -0.061 ns
Table 5–48. EP2S30 Column Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.553 1.627 2.639 3.025 3.509 ns
tCOUT 1.396 1.462 2.397 2.747 3.185 ns
tPLLCIN 0.114 0.113 0.225 0.248 0.28 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.043 -0.052 -0.017 -0.03 -0.044 ns
Table 5–49. EP2S30 Column Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.539 1.613 2.622 3.008 3.501 ns
tCOUT 1.382 1.448 2.380 2.730 3.177 ns
tPLLCIN 0.101 0.098 0.209 0.229 0.267 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.056 -0.067 -0.033 -0.049 -0.057 ns
5–44 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
EP2S60 Clock Timing Parameters
Tables 5–52 through 5–55 show the maximum clock timing parameters
for EP2S60 devices.
Table 5–50. EP2S30 Row Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.304 1.184 1.966 2.251 2.616 ns
tCOUT 1.309 1.189 1.962 2.247 2.611 ns
tPLLCIN -0.135 –0.158 –0.208 –0.254 –0.302 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.13 –0.153 –0.212 –0.258 –0.307 ns
Table 5–51. EP2S30 Row Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.289 1.352 2.238 2.567 2.990 ns
tCOUT 1.294 1.357 2.234 2.563 2.985 ns
tPLLCIN -0.14 -0.154 -0.169 -0.205 -0.254 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.135 -0.149 -0.173 -0.209 -0.259 ns
Table 5–52. EP2S60 Column Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.681 1.762 2.945 3.381 3.931 ns
tCOUT 1.524 1.597 2.703 3.103 3.607 ns
tPLLCIN 0.066 0.064 0.279 0.311 0.348 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.091 -0.101 0.037 0.033 0.024 ns
Altera Corporation 5–45
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–53. EP2S60 Column Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.658 1.739 2.920 3.350 3.899 ns
tCOUT 1.501 1.574 2.678 3.072 3.575 ns
tPLLCIN 0.06 0.057 0.278 0.304 0.355 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.097 -0.108 0.036 0.026 0.031 ns
Table 5–54. EP2S60 Row Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.463 1.532 2.591 2.972 3.453 ns
tCOUT 1.468 1.537 2.587 2.968 3.448 ns
tPLLCIN -0.153 -0.167 -0.079 -0.099 -0.128 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.148 -0.162 -0.083 -0.103 -0.133 ns
Table 5–55. EP2S60 Row Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.439 1.508 2.562 2.940 3.421 ns
tCOUT 1.444 1.513 2.558 2.936 3.416 ns
tPLLCIN -0.161 -0.174 -0.083 -0.107 -0.126 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.156 -0.169 -0.087 -0.111 -0.131 ns
5–46 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
EP2S90 Clock Timing Parameters
Tables 5–56 through 5–59 show the maximum clock timing parameters
for EP2S90 devices.
Table 5–56. EP2S90 Column Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.768 1.850 3.033 3.473 4.040 ns
tCOUT 1.611 1.685 2.791 3.195 3.716 ns
tPLLCIN -0.127 -0.117 0.125 0.129 0.144 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.284 -0.282 -0.117 -0.149 -0.18 ns
Table 5–57. EP2S90 Column Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.783 1.868 3.058 3.502 4.070 ns
tCOUT 1.626 1.703 2.816 3.224 3.746 ns
tPLLCIN -0.137 -0.127 0.115 0.119 0.134 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.294 -0.292 -0.127 -0.159 -0.19 ns
Table 5–58. EP2S90 Row Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.566 1.638 2.731 3.124 3.632 ns
tCOUT 1.571 1.643 2.727 3.120 3.627 ns
tPLLCIN -0.326 -0.326 -0.178 -0.218 -0.264 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.321 -0.321 -0.182 -0.222 -0.269 ns
Altera Corporation 5–47
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
EP2S130 Clock Timing Parameters
Tables 5–60 through 5–63 show the maximum clock timing parameters
for EP2S130 devices.
Table 5–59. EP2S90 Row Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.585 1.658 2.757 3.154 3.665 ns
tCOUT 1.590 1.663 2.753 3.150 3.660 ns
tPLLCIN -0.341 -0.341 -0.193 -0.235 -0.278 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.336 -0.336 -0.197 -0.239 -0.283 ns
Table 5–60. EP2S130 Column Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.889 1.981 3.405 3.722 4.326 ns
tCOUT 1.732 1.816 3.151 3.444 4.002 ns
tPLLCIN 0.105 0.106 0.226 0.242 0.277 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.052 -0.059 -0.028 -0.036 -0.047 ns
Table 5–61. EP2S130 Column Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.907 1.998 3.420 3.740 4.348 ns
tCOUT 1.750 1.833 3.166 3.462 4.024 ns
tPLLCIN 0.134 0.136 0.276 0.296 0.338 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.023 -0.029 0.022 0.018 0.014 ns
5–48 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
EP2S180 Clock Timing Parameters
Tables 5–64 through 5–67 show the maximum clock timing parameters
for EP2S180 devices.
Table 5–62. EP2S130 Row Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.680 1.760 3.070 3.351 3.892 ns
tCOUT 1.685 1.765 3.066 3.347 3.887 ns
tPLLCIN -0.113 -0.124 -0.12 -0.138 -0.168 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.108 -0.119 -0.124 -0.142 -0.173 ns
Table 5–63. EP2S130 Row Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.690 1.770 3.075 3.362 3.905 ns
tCOUT 1.695 1.775 3.071 3.358 3.900 ns
tPLLCIN -0.087 -0.097 -0.075 -0.089 -0.11 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.082 -0.092 -0.079 -0.093 -0.115 ns
Table 5–64. EP2S180 Column Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 2.001 2.095 3.643 3.984 4.634 ns
tCOUT 1.844 1.930 3.389 3.706 4.310 ns
tPLLCIN -0.307 -0.297 0.053 0.046 0.048 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.464 -0.462 -0.201 -0.232 -0.276 ns
Altera Corporation 5–49
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–65. EP2S180 Column Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 2.003 2.100 3.652 3.993 4.648 ns
tCOUT 1.846 1.935 3.398 3.715 4.324 ns
tPLLCIN -0.3 -0.29 0.053 0.054 0.058 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.457 -0.455 -0.201 -0.224 -0.266 ns
Table 5–66. EP2S180 Row Pins Regional Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.759 1.844 3.273 3.577 4.162 ns
tCOUT 1.764 1.849 3.269 3.573 4.157 ns
tPLLCIN -0.542 -0.541 -0.317 -0.353 -0.414 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.537 -0.536 -0.321 -0.357 -0.419 ns
Table 5–67. EP2S180 Row Pins Global Clock Timing Parameters
Parameter Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
tCIN 1.763 1.850 3.285 3.588 4.176 ns
tCOUT 1.768 1.855 3.281 3.584 4.171 ns
tPLLCIN -0.542 -0.542 -0.319 -0.355 -0.42 ns
tPLLCOUT -0.537 -0.537 -0.323 -0.359 -0.425 ns
5–50 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Clock Network Skew Adders
The Quartus II software models skew within dedicated clock networks
such as global and regional clocks. Therefore, intra-clock network skew
adder is not specified. Table 568 specifies the clock skew between any
two clock networks driving registers in the IOE.
Table 5–68. Clock Network Specifications
Name Description Min Typ Max Unit
Clock skew adder
EP2S15, EP2S30,
EP2S60 (1)
Inter-clock network, same side ±50 ps
Inter-clock network, entire chip ±100 ps
Clock skew adder
EP2S90 (1)
Inter-clock network, same side ±55 ps
Inter-clock network, entire chip ±110 ps
Clock skew adder
EP2S130 (1)
Inter-clock network, same side ±63 ps
Inter-clock network, entire chip ±125 ps
Clock skew adder
EP2S180 (1)
Inter-clock network, same side ±75 ps
Inter-clock network, entire chip ±150 ps
Note to Table 5–68:
(1) This is in addition to intra-clock network skew, which is modeled in the Quartus II software.
Altera Corporation 5–51
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
IOE Programmable Delay
See Tables 5–69 and 5–70 for IOE programmable delay.
Table 5–69. Stratix II IOE Programmable Delay on Column Pins Note (1)
Parameter Paths Affected Available
Settings
Minimum
Timing (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Input delay from
pin to internal
cells
Pad to I/O
dataout to logic
array
80
0
1,696
1,781
0
0
2,881
3,025
0 3,313 0 3,860
Input delay from
pin to input
register
Pad to I/O input
register
64 0
0
1,955
2,053
0
0
3,275
3,439
0 3,766 0 4,388
Delay from
output register
to output pin
I/O output
register to pad
20
0
316
332
0
0
500
525
0 575 0 670
Output enable
pin delay
tXZ, tZX 20
0
305
320
0
0
483
507
0 556 0 647
Notes to Table 5–69:
(1) The incremental values for the settings are generally linear. For the exact delay associated with each setting, use the
latest version of the Quartus II software.
(2) The first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second number is the minimum
timing parameter for commercial devices.
(3) The first number applies to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices. The second number
applies to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
5–52 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Default Capacitive Loading of Different I/O Standards
See Table 5–71 for default capacitive loading of different I/O standards.
Table 5–70. Stratix II IOE Programmable Delay on Row Pins Note (1)
Parameter Paths Affected Available
Settings
Minimum
Timing (2)
-3 Speed
Grade (3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Min
Offset
(ps)
Max
Offset
(ps)
Input delay from
pin to internal
cells
Pad to I/O
dataout to logic
array
80
0
1,697
1,782
0
0
2,876
3,020
0 3,308 0 3,853
Input delay from
pin to input
register
Pad to I/O input
register
64 0
0
1,956
2,054
0
0
3,270
3,434
0 3,761 0 4,381
Delay from
output register
to output pin
I/O output
register to pad
20
0
316
332
0
0
525
525
0 575 0 670
Output enable
pin delay
tXZ, tZX 20
0
305
320
0
0
507
507
0 556 0 647
Notes to Table 5–70:
(1) The incremental values for the settings are generally linear. For the exact delay associated with each setting, use the
latest version of the Quartus II software.
(2) The first number is the minimum timing parameter for industrial devices. The second number is the minimum
timing parameter for commercial devices.
(3) The first number applies to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices. The second number
applies to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
Table 5–71. Default Loading of Different I/O Standards for Stratix II (Part 1
of 2)
I/O Standard Capacitive Load Unit
LVTTL 0 pF
LVCMOS 0 p F
2.5 V 0 pF
1.8 V 0 pF
1.5 V 0 pF
PCI 10 pF
PCI-X 10 pF
SSTL-2 Class I 0 pF
Altera Corporation 5–53
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
SSTL-2 Class II 0 pF
SSTL-18 Class I 0 pF
SSTL-18 Class II 0 pF
1.5-V HSTL Class I 0 pF
1.5-V HSTL Class II 0 pF
1.8-V HSTL Class I 0 pF
1.8-V HSTL Class II 0 pF
1.2-V HSTL with OCT 0 pF
Differential SSTL-2 Class I 0 pF
Differential SSTL-2 Class II 0 pF
Differential SSTL-18 Class I 0 pF
Differential SSTL-18 Class II 0 pF
1.5-V Differential HSTL Class I 0 pF
1.5-V Differential HSTL Class II 0 pF
1.8-V Differential HSTL Class I 0 pF
1.8-V Differential HSTL Class II 0 pF
LVDS 0 pF
HyperTransport 0 pF
LVPECL 0 pF
Table 5–71. Default Loading of Different I/O Standards for Stratix II (Part 2
of 2)
I/O Standard Capacitive Load Unit
5–54 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
I/O Delays
See Tables 5–72 through 5–76 for I/O delays.
Table 5–72. I/O Delay Parameters
Symbol Parameter
tDIP Delay from I/O datain to output pad
tOP Delay from I/O output register to output pad
tPCOUT Delay from input pad to I/O dataout to core
tPI Delay from input pad to I/O input register
Table 5–73. Stratix II I/O Input Delay for Column Pins (Part 1 of 3)
I/O Standard Parameter
Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
(2)
-3 Speed
Grade
(3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
LVT TL tPI 674 707 1223 1282 1405 1637 ps
tPCOUT 408 428 787 825 904 1054 ps
2.5 V tPI 684 717 1210 1269 1390 1619 ps
tPCOUT 418 438 774 812 889 1036 ps
1.8 V tPI 747 783 1366 1433 1570 1829 ps
tPCOUT 481 504 930 976 1069 1246 ps
1.5 V tPI 749 786 1436 1506 1650 1922 ps
tPCOUT 483 507 1000 1049 1149 1339 ps
LVCMOS t PI 674 707 1223 1282 1405 1637 ps
tPCOUT 408 428 787 825 904 1054 ps
SSTL-2 Class I tPI 507 530 818 857 939 1094 ps
tPCOUT 241 251 382 400 438 511 ps
SSTL-2 Class II tPI 507 530 818 857 939 1094 ps
tPCOUT 241 251 382 400 438 511 ps
SSTL-18 Class I tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
SSTL-18 Class II tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
tPI 560 587 993 1041 1141 1329 ps
tPCOUT 294 308 557 584 640 746 ps
Altera Corporation 5–55
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
1.5-V HSTL
Class II
tPI 560 587 993 1041 1141 1329 ps
tPCOUT 294 308 557 584 640 746 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
PCI tPI 679 712 1214 1273 1395 1625 ps
tPCOUT 413 433 778 816 894 1042 ps
PCI-X tPI 679 712 1214 1273 1395 1625 ps
tPCOUT 413 433 778 816 894 1042 ps
Differential
SSTL-2 Class I
(1)
tPI 507 530 818 857 939 1094 ps
tPCOUT 241 251 382 400 438 511 ps
Differential
SSTL-2 Class II
(1)
tPI 507 530 818 857 939 1094 ps
tPCOUT 241 251 382 400 438 511 ps
Differential
SSTL-18 Class I
(1)
tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
Differential
SSTL-18 Class II
(1)
tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class I (1)
tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class II (1)
tPI 543 569 898 941 1031 1201 ps
tPCOUT 277 290 462 484 530 618 ps
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class I (1)
tPI 560 587 993 1041 1141 1329 ps
tPCOUT 294 308 557 584 640 746 ps
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class II (1)
tPI 560 587 993 1041 1141 1329 ps
tPCOUT 294 308 557 584 640 746 ps
Table 5–73. Stratix II I/O Input Delay for Column Pins (Part 2 of 3)
I/O Standard Parameter
Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
(2)
-3 Speed
Grade
(3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
5–56 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
1.2-V HSTL tPI 645 677 1194 1252 - - ps
tPCOUT 379 398 758 795 - - ps
Notes for Table 57 3 :
(1) These I/O standards are only supported on DQS pins.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
Table 5–74. Stratix II I/O Input Delay for Row Pins (Part 1 of 2)
I/O Standard Parameter
Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
(1)
-3 Speed
Grade
(2)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
LVT TL tPI 715 749 1287 1350 1477 1723 ps
tPCOUT 391 410 760 798 873 1018 ps
2.5 V tPI 726 761 1273 1335 1461 1704 ps
tPCOUT 402 422 746 783 857 999 ps
1.8 V tPI 788 827 1427 1497 1639 1911 ps
tPCOUT 464 488 900 945 1035 1206 ps
1.5 V tPI 792 830 1498 1571 1720 2006 ps
tPCOUT 468 491 971 1019 1116 1301 ps
LVCMOS t PI 715 749 1287 1350 1477 1723 ps
tPCOUT 391 410 760 798 873 1018 ps
SSTL-2 Class I tPI 547 573 879 921 1008 1176 ps
tPCOUT 223 234 352 369 404 471 ps
SSTL-2 Class II tPI 547 573 879 921 1008 1176 ps
tPCOUT 223 234 352 369 404 471 ps
SSTL-18 Class I tPI 577 605 960 1006 1101 1285 ps
tPCOUT 253 266 433 454 497 580 ps
SSTL-18 Class II tPI 577 605 960 1006 1101 1285 ps
tPCOUT 253 266 433 454 497 580 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
tPI 602 631 1056 1107 1212 1413 ps
tPCOUT 278 292 529 555 608 708 ps
Table 5–73. Stratix II I/O Input Delay for Column Pins (Part 3 of 3)
I/O Standard Parameter
Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
(2)
-3 Speed
Grade
(3)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
Altera Corporation 5–57
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
1.5-V HSTL
Class II
tPI 602 631 1056 1107 1212 1413 ps
tPCOUT 278 292 529 555 608 708 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
tPI 577 605 960 1006 1101 1285 ps
tPCOUT 253 266 433 454 497 580 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
tPI 577 605 960 1006 1101 1285 ps
tPCOUT 253 266 433 454 497 580 ps
LVDS tPI 515 540 948 994 1088 1269 ps
tPCOUT 191 201 421 442 484 564 ps
HyperTransport tPI 515 540 948 994 1088 1269 ps
tPCOUT 191 201 421 442 484 564 ps
Notes for Table 57 4 :
(1) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 1 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
LVTTL 4 mA tOP 1178 1236 2351 2467 2702 2820 ps
tDIP 1198 1258 2417 2537 2778 2910 ps
8 mA tOP 1041 1091 2036 2136 2340 2448 ps
tDIP 1061 1113 2102 2206 2416 2538 ps
12 mA tOP 976 1024 2036 2136 2340 2448 ps
tDIP 996 1046 2102 2206 2416 2538 ps
16 mA tOP 951 998 1893 1986 2176 2279 ps
tDIP 971 1020 1959 2056 2252 2369 ps
20 mA tOP 931 976 1787 1875 2054 2154 ps
tDIP 951 998 1853 1945 2130 2244 ps
24 mA
(1)
tOP 924 969 1788 1876 2055 2156 ps
tDIP 944 991 1854 1946 2131 2246 ps
Table 5–74. Stratix II I/O Input Delay for Row Pins (Part 2 of 2)
I/O Standard Parameter
Minimum Timing -3 Speed
Grade
(1)
-3 Speed
Grade
(2)
-4 Speed
Grade
-5 Speed
Grade Unit
Industrial Commercial
5–58 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
LVCMOS 4 m A tOP 1041 1091 2036 2136 2340 2448 ps
tDIP 1061 1113 2102 2206 2416 2538 ps
8 mA tOP 952 999 1786 1874 2053 2153 ps
tDIP 972 1021 1852 1944 2129 2243 ps
12 mA tOP 926 971 1720 1805 1977 2075 ps
tDIP 946 993 1786 1875 2053 2165 ps
16 mA tOP 933 978 1693 1776 1946 2043 ps
tDIP 953 1000 1759 1846 2022 2133 ps
20 mA tOP 921 965 1677 1759 1927 2025 ps
tDIP 941 987 1743 1829 2003 2115 ps
24 mA
(1)
tOP 909 954 1659 1741 1906 2003 ps
tDIP 929 976 1725 1811 1982 2093 ps
2.5 V 4 mA tOP 1004 1053 2063 2165 2371 2480 ps
tDIP 1024 1075 2129 2235 2447 2570 ps
8 mA tOP 955 1001 1841 1932 2116 2218 ps
tDIP 975 1023 1907 2002 2192 2308 ps
12 mA tOP 934 980 1742 1828 2002 2101 ps
tDIP 954 1002 1808 1898 2078 2191 ps
16 mA
(1)
tOP 918 962 1679 1762 1929 2027 ps
tDIP 938 984 1745 1832 2005 2117 ps
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 2 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
Altera Corporation 5–59
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
1.8 V 2 mA tOP 1042 1093 2904 3048 3338 3472 ps
tDIP 1062 1115 2970 3118 3414 3562 ps
4 mA tOP 1047 1098 2248 2359 2584 2698 ps
tDIP 1067 1120 2314 2429 2660 2788 ps
6 mA tOP 974 1022 2024 2124 2326 2434 ps
tDIP 994 1044 2090 2194 2402 2524 ps
8 mA tOP 976 1024 1947 2043 2238 2343 ps
tDIP 996 1046 2013 2113 2314 2433 ps
10 mA tOP 933 978 1882 1975 2163 2266 ps
tDIP 953 1000 1948 2045 2239 2356 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 934 979 1833 1923 2107 2209 ps
tDIP 954 1001 1899 1993 2183 2299 ps
1.5 V 2 mA tOP 1023 1073 2505 2629 2879 3002 ps
tDIP 1043 1095 2571 2699 2955 3092 ps
4 mA tOP 963 1009 2023 2123 2325 2433 ps
tDIP 983 1031 2089 2193 2401 2523 ps
6 mA tOP 966 1012 1923 2018 2210 2315 ps
tDIP 986 1034 1989 2088 2286 2405 ps
8 mA (1) tOP 926 971 1878 1970 2158 2262 ps
tDIP 946 993 1944 2040 2234 2352 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 8 mA tOP 913 957 1715 1799 1971 2041 ps
tDIP 933 979 1781 1869 2047 2131 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 896 940 1672 1754 1921 1991 ps
tDIP 916 962 1738 1824 1997 2081 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 16 mA tOP 876 918 1609 1688 1849 1918 ps
tDIP 896 940 1675 1758 1925 2008 ps
20 mA tOP 877 919 1598 1676 1836 1905 ps
tDIP 897 941 1664 1746 1912 1995 ps
24 mA
(1)
tOP 872 915 1596 1674 1834 1903 ps
tDIP 892 937 1662 1744 1910 1993 ps
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 3 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
5–60 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
SSTL-18
Class I
4 mA tOP 909 953 1690 1773 1942 2012 ps
tDIP 929 975 1756 1843 2018 2102 ps
6 mA tOP 914 958 1656 1737 1903 1973 ps
tDIP 934 980 1722 1807 1979 2063 ps
8 mA tOP 894 937 1640 1721 1885 1954 ps
tDIP 914 959 1706 1791 1961 2044 ps
10 mA tOP 898 942 1638 1718 1882 1952 ps
tDIP 918 964 1704 1788 1958 2042 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 891 936 1626 1706 1869 1938 ps
tDIP 911 958 1692 1776 1945 2028 ps
SSTL-18
Class II
8 mA tOP 883 925 1597 1675 1835 1904 ps
tDIP 903 947 1663 1745 1911 1994 ps
16 mA tOP 894 937 1578 1655 1813 1882 ps
tDIP 914 959 1644 1725 1889 1972 ps
18 mA tOP 890 933 1585 1663 1821 1890 ps
tDIP 910 955 1651 1733 1897 1980 ps
20 mA
(1)
tOP 890 933 1583 1661 1819 1888 ps
tDIP 910 955 1649 1731 1895 1978 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA tOP 912 956 1608 1687 1848 1943 ps
tDIP 932 978 1674 1757 1924 2033 ps
6 mA tOP 917 962 1595 1673 1833 1928 ps
tDIP 937 984 1661 1743 1909 2018 ps
8 mA tOP 896 940 1586 1664 1823 1917 ps
tDIP 916 962 1652 1734 1899 2007 ps
10 mA tOP 900 944 1591 1669 1828 1923 ps
tDIP 920 966 1657 1739 1904 2013 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 892 936 1585 1663 1821 1916 ps
tDIP 912 958 1651 1733 1897 2006 ps
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 4 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
Altera Corporation 5–61
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
16 mA tOP 877 919 1385 1453 1591 1680 ps
tDIP 897 941 1451 1523 1667 1770 ps
18 mA tOP 879 921 1394 1462 1602 1691 ps
tDIP 899 943 1460 1532 1678 1781 ps
20 mA
(1)
tOP 879 921 1402 1471 1611 1700 ps
tDIP 899 943 1468 1541 1687 1790 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA tOP 912 956 1607 1686 1847 1942 ps
tDIP 932 978 1673 1756 1923 2032 ps
6 mA tOP 917 961 1588 1666 1825 1920 ps
tDIP 937 983 1654 1736 1901 2010 ps
8 mA tOP 899 943 1590 1668 1827 1922 ps
tDIP 919 965 1656 1738 1903 2012 ps
10 mA tOP 900 943 1592 1670 1829 1924 ps
tDIP 920 965 1658 1740 1905 2014 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 893 937 1590 1668 1827 1922 ps
tDIP 913 959 1656 1738 1903 2012 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class II
16 mA tOP 881 924 1431 1501 1644 1734 ps
tDIP 901 946 1497 1571 1720 1824 ps
18 mA tOP 884 927 1439 1510 1654 1744 ps
tDIP 904 949 1505 1580 1730 1834 ps
20 mA
(1)
tOP 886 929 1450 1521 1666 1757 ps
tDIP 906 951 1516 1591 1742 1847 ps
1.2-V HSTL tOP 958 1004 1602 1681 - - ps
tDIP 978 1026 1668 1751 - - ps
PCI tOP 1028 1082 1956 2051 2244 2070 ps
tDIP 1048 1104 2022 2121 2320 2160 ps
PCI-X tOP 1028 1082 1956 2051 2244 2070 ps
tDIP 1048 1104 2022 2121 2320 2160 ps
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 5 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
5–62 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Differential
SSTL-2 Class I
8 mA tOP 913 957 1715 1799 1971 2041 ps
tDIP 933 979 1781 1869 2047 2131 ps
12 mA tOP 896 940 1672 1754 1921 1991 ps
tDIP 916 962 1738 1824 1997 2081 ps
Differential
SSTL-2 Class II
16 mA tOP 876 918 1609 1688 1849 1918 ps
tDIP 896 940 1675 1758 1925 2008 ps
20 mA tOP 877 919 1598 1676 1836 1905 ps
tDIP 897 941 1664 1746 1912 1995 ps
24 mA tOP 872 915 1596 1674 1834 1903 ps
tDIP 892 937 1662 1744 1910 1993 ps
Differential
SSTL-18
Class I
4 mA tOP 909 953 1690 1773 1942 2012 ps
tDIP 929 975 1756 1843 2018 2102 ps
6 mA tOP 914 958 1656 1737 1903 1973 ps
tDIP 934 980 1722 1807 1979 2063 ps
8 mA tOP 894 937 1640 1721 1885 1954 ps
tDIP 914 959 1706 1791 1961 2044 ps
10 mA tOP 898 942 1638 1718 1882 1952 ps
tDIP 918 964 1704 1788 1958 2042 ps
12 mA tOP 891 936 1626 1706 1869 1938 ps
tDIP 911 958 1692 1776 1945 2028 ps
Differential
SSTL-18
Class II
8 mA tOP 883 925 1597 1675 1835 1904 ps
tDIP 903 947 1663 1745 1911 1994 ps
16 mA tOP 894 937 1578 1655 1813 1882 ps
tDIP 914 959 1644 1725 1889 1972 ps
18 mA tOP 890 933 1585 1663 1821 1890 ps
tDIP 910 955 1651 1733 1897 1980 ps
20 mA tOP 890 933 1583 1661 1819 1888 ps
tDIP 910 955 1649 1731 1895 1978 ps
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 6 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
Altera Corporation 5–63
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
1.8-V
Differential
HSTL Class I
4 mA tOP 912 956 1608 1687 1848 1943 ps
tDIP 932 978 1674 1757 1924 2033 ps
6 mA tOP 917 962 1595 1673 1833 1928 ps
tDIP 937 984 1661 1743 1909 2018 ps
8 mA tOP 896 940 1586 1664 1823 1917 ps
tDIP 916 962 1652 1734 1899 2007 ps
10 mA tOP 900 944 1591 1669 1828 1923 ps
tDIP 920 966 1657 1739 1904 2013 ps
12 mA tOP 892 936 1585 1663 1821 1916 ps
tDIP 912 958 1651 1733 1897 2006 ps
1.8-V
Differential
HSTL Class II
16 mA tOP 877 919 1385 1453 1591 1680 ps
tDIP 897 941 1451 1523 1667 1770 ps
18 mA tOP 879 921 1394 1462 1602 1691 ps
tDIP 899 943 1460 1532 1678 1781 ps
20 mA tOP 879 921 1402 1471 1611 1700 ps
tDIP 899 943 1468 1541 1687 1790 ps
1.5-V
Differential
HSTL Class I
4 mA tOP 912 956 1607 1686 1847 1942 ps
tDIP 932 978 1673 1756 1923 2032 ps
6 mA tOP 917 961 1588 1666 1825 1920 ps
tDIP 937 983 1654 1736 1901 2010 ps
8 mA tOP 899 943 1590 1668 1827 1922 ps
tDIP 919 965 1656 1738 1903 2012 ps
10 mA tOP 900 943 1592 1670 1829 1924 ps
tDIP 920 965 1658 1740 1905 2014 ps
12 mA tOP 893 937 1590 1668 1827 1922
tDIP 913 959 1656 1738 1903 2012
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 7 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
5–64 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
1.5-V
Differential
HSTL Class II
16 mA tOP 881 924 1431 1501 1644 1734 ps
tDIP 901 946 1497 1571 1720 1824 ps
18 mA tOP 884 927 1439 1510 1654 1744
tDIP 904 949 1505 1580 1730 1834
20 mA tOP 886 929 1450 1521 1666 1757
tDIP 906 951 1516 1591 1742 1847
Notes to Table 5–75:
(1) This is the default setting in the Quartus II software.
(2) These I/O standards are only supported on DQS pins.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(4) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
Table 5–76. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Row Pins (Part 1 of 3)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
LVT TL 4 m A tOP 1267 1328 2655 2786 3052 3189 ps
tDIP 1225 1285 2600 2729 2989 3116 ps
8 mA tOP 1144 1200 2113 2217 2429 2549 ps
tDIP 1102 1157 2058 2160 2366 2476 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 1091 1144 2081 2184 2392 2512 ps
tDIP 1049 1101 2026 2127 2329 2439 ps
LVCMOS 4 m A tOP 1144 1200 2113 2217 2429 2549 ps
tDIP 1102 1157 2058 2160 2366 2476 ps
8 mA (1) tOP 1044 1094 1853 1944 2130 2243 ps
tDIP 1002 1051 1798 1887 2067 2170 ps
Table 5–75. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Column Pins (Part 8 of 8)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-3
Speed
Grade
(4)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
Altera Corporation 5–65
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
2.5 V 4 mA tOP 1128 1183 2091 2194 2403 2523 ps
tDIP 1086 1140 2036 2137 2340 2450 ps
8 mA tOP 1030 1080 1872 1964 2152 2265 ps
tDIP 988 1037 1817 1907 2089 2192 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 1012 1061 1775 1862 2040 2151 ps
tDIP 970 1018 1720 1805 1977 2078 ps
1.8 V 2 mA tOP 1196 1253 2954 3100 3396 3542 ps
tDIP 1154 1210 2899 3043 3333 3469 ps
4 mA tOP 1184 1242 2294 2407 2637 2763 ps
tDIP 1142 1199 2239 2350 2574 2690 ps
6 mA tOP 1079 1131 2039 2140 2344 2462 ps
tDIP 1037 1088 1984 2083 2281 2389 ps
8 mA (1) tOP 1049 1100 1942 2038 2232 2348 ps
tDIP 1007 1057 1887 1981 2169 2275 ps
1.5 V 2 mA tOP 1158 1213 2530 2655 2908 3041 ps
tDIP 1116 1170 2475 2598 2845 2968 ps
4 mA tOP 1055 1106 2020 2120 2322 2440 ps
tDIP 1013 1063 1965 2063 2259 2367 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 8 mA tOP 1002 1050 1759 1846 2022 2104 ps
tDIP 960 1007 1704 1789 1959 2031 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 16 mA
(1)
tOP 947 992 1581 1659 1817 1897 ps
tDIP 905 949 1526 1602 1754 1824 ps
SSTL-18
Class I
4 mA tOP 990 1038 1709 1793 1964 2046 ps
tDIP 948 995 1654 1736 1901 1973 ps
6 mA tOP 994 1042 1648 1729 1894 1975 ps
tDIP 952 999 1593 1672 1831 1902 ps
8 mA tOP 970 1018 1633 1713 1877 1958 ps
tDIP 928 975 1578 1656 1814 1885 ps
10 mA
(1)
tOP 974 1021 1615 1694 1856 1937 ps
tDIP 932 978 1560 1637 1793 1864 ps
Table 5–76. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Row Pins (Part 2 of 3)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
5–66 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Maximum Input & Output Clock Toggle Rate
Maximum clock toggle rate is defined as the maximum frequency
achievable for a clock type signal at an I/O pin. The I/O pin can be a
regular I/O pin or a dedicated clock I/O pin.
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA tOP 972 1019 1610 1689 1850 1956 ps
tDIP 930 976 1555 1632 1787 1883 ps
6 mA tOP 975 1022 1580 1658 1816 1920 ps
tDIP 933 979 1525 1601 1753 1847 ps
8 mA tOP 958 1004 1576 1653 1811 1916 ps
tDIP 916 961 1521 1596 1748 1843 ps
10 mA tOP 962 1008 1567 1644 1801 1905 ps
tDIP 920 965 1512 1587 1738 1832 ps
12 mA
(1)
tOP 953 999 1566 1643 1800 1904 ps
tDIP 911 956 1511 1586 1737 1831 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA tOP 970 1018 1591 1669 1828 1933 ps
tDIP 928 975 1536 1612 1765 1860 ps
6 mA tOP 974 1021 1579 1657 1815 1919 ps
tDIP 932 978 1524 1600 1752 1846 ps
8 mA (1) tOP 960 1006 1572 1649 1807 1911 ps
tDIP 918 963 1517 1592 1744 1838 ps
LVDS tOP 1018 1067 1723 1808 1980 2089 ps
tDIP 976 1024 1668 1751 1917 2016 ps
HyperTransport tOP 1005 1053 1723 1808 1980 2089 ps
tDIP 963 1010 1668 1751 1917 2016 ps
Notes to Table 5–76:
(1) This is the default setting in the Quartus II software.
(2) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S15, EP2S30, EP2S60, and EP2S90 devices.
(3) These numbers apply to -3 speed grade EP2S130 and EP2S180 devices.
Table 5–76. Stratix II I/O Output Delay for Row Pins (Part 3 of 3)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength Parameter
Minimum Timing -3
Speed
Grade
(2)
-3
Speed
Grade
(3)
-4
Speed
Grade
-5
Speed
Grade
Unit
Industrial Commercial
Altera Corporation 5–67
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
The maximum clock toggle rate is different from the maximum data bit
rate. If the maximum clock toggle rate on a regular I/O pin is 300 MHz,
the maximum data bit rate for dual data rate (DDR) could be potentially
as high as 600 Mbps on the same I/O pin.
Table 5–77 specifies the maximum input clock toggle rates. Table 5–78
specifies the maximum output clock toggle rates at 0pF load. Table 5–79
specifies the derating factors for the output clock toggle rate for a non 0pF
load.
To calculate the output toggle rate for a non 0pF load, use this formula:
The toggle rate for a non 0pF load
= 1000 / (1000/ toggle rate at 0pF load + derating factor * load value
in pF /1000)
For example, the output toggle rate at 0pF load for SSTL-18 Class II 20mA
I/O standard is 550 MHz on a -3 device clock output pin. The derating
factor is 94ps/pF. For a 10pF load the toggle rate is calculated as:
1000 / (1000/550 + 94 × 10 /1000) = 363 (MHz)
Tables 5–77 through 5–79 show the I/O toggle rates for Stratix II
devices.
Table 5–77. Maximum Input Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 1 of 2)
Input I/O Standard Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Dedicated Clock Inputs
(MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
LVTTL 500 500 450 500 500 450 500 500 400
2.5-V LVTTL/CMOS 500 500 450 500 500 450 500 500 400
1.8-V LVTTL/CMOS 500 500 450 500 500 450 500 500 400
1.5-V LVTTL/CMOS 500 500 450 500 500 450 500 500 400
LVCMOS 500 500 450 500 500 450 500 500 400
SSTL-2 Class I 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
SSTL-2 Class II 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
SSTL-18 Class I 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
SSTL-18 Class II 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
1.5-V HSTL Class I 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
1.5-V HSTL Class II 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
1.8-V HSTL Class I 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
5–68 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
1.8-V HSTL Class II 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500 500
PCI (1) 500 500 450 - - - 500 500 400
PCI-X (1) 500 500 450 - - - 500 500 400
1.2-V HSTL (2) 280 - - - - - 280 - -
Differential SSTL-2 Class I
(1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
Differential SSTL-2 Class II
(1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
Differential SSTL-18 Class I
(1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
Differential SSTL-18 Class II
(1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
1.8-V Differential HSTL
Class I (1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
1.8-V Differential HSTL
Class II (1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
1.5-V Differential HSTL
Class I (1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
1.5-V Differential HSTL
Class II (1), (3)
500 500 500 - - - 500 500 500
HyperTransport technology
(4)
- - - 520 520 420 717 717 640
LVPECL (1) - - - - - - 450 450 400
LVDS (5) - - - 520 520 420 717 717 640
LVDS (6) - - - - - - 450 450 400
Notes to Table 5–77:
(1) Row clock inputs don’t support PCI, PCI-X, LVPECL, and differential HSTL and SSTL standards.
(2) 1.2-V HSTL is only supported on column I/O pins.
(3) Differential HSTL and SSTL standards are only supported on column clock and DQS inputs.
(4) HyperTransport technology is only supported on row I/O and row dedicated clock input pins.
(5) These numbers apply to I/O pins and dedicated clock pins in the left and right I/O banks.
(6) These numbers apply to dedicated clock pins in the top and bottom I/O banks.
Table 5–77. Maximum Input Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 2 of 2)
Input I/O Standard Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Dedicated Clock Inputs
(MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
Altera Corporation 5–69
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–78. Maximum Output Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 1 of 5) Note (1)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Clock Outputs (MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
3.3-V LVTTL 4 mA 270 225 210 270 225 210 270 225 210
8 mA 435 355 325 435 355 325 435 355 325
12 mA 580 475 420 580 475 420 580 475 420
16 mA 720 594 520 - - - 720 594 520
20 mA 875 700 610 - - - 875 700 610
24 mA 1,030 794 670 - - - 1,030 794 670
3.3-V LVCMOS 4 mA 290 250 230 290 250 230 290 250 230
8 mA 565 480 440 565 480 440 565 480 440
12 mA 790 710 670 - - - 790 710 670
16 mA 1,020 925 875 - - - 1,020 925 875
20 mA 1,066 985 935 - - - 1,066 985 935
24 mA 1,100 1,040 1,000 - - - 1,100 1,040 1,000
2.5-V
LVTTL/LVCMOS
4 mA 230 194 180 230 194 180 230 194 180
8 mA 430 380 380 430 380 380 430 380 380
12 mA 630 575 550 630 575 550 630 575 550
16 mA 930 845 820 - - - 930 845 820
1.8-V
LVTTL/LVCMOS
2 mA 120 109 104 120 109 104 120 109 104
4 mA 285 250 230 285 250 230 285 250 230
6 mA 450 390 360 450 390 360 450 390 360
8 mA 660 570 520 660 570 520 660 570 520
10 mA 905 805 755 - - - 905 805 755
12 mA 1,131 1,040 990 - - - 1,131 1,040 990
1.5-V
LVTTL/LVCMOS
2 mA 244 200 180 244 200 180 244 200 180
4 mA 470 370 325 470 370 325 470 370 325
6 mA 550 430 375 - - - 550 430 375
8 mA 625 495 420 - - - 625 495 420
SSTL-2 Class I 8 mA 400 300 300 - - - 400 300 300
12 mA 400 400 350 400 350 350 400 400 350
SSTL-2 Class II 16 mA 350 350 300 350 350 300 350 350 300
20 mA 400 350 350 - - - 400 350 350
24 mA 400 400 350 - - - 400 400 350
5–70 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
SSTL-18 Class I 4 mA 200 150 150 200 150 150 200 150 150
6 mA 350 250 200 350 250 200 350 250 200
8 mA 450 300 300 450 300 300 450 300 300
10 mA 500 400 400 500 400 400 500 400 400
12 mA 700 550 400 - - - 650 550 400
SSTL-18 Class II 8 mA 200 200 150 - - - 200 200 150
16 mA 400 350 350 - - - 400 350 350
18 mA 450 400 400 - - - 450 400 400
20 mA 550 500 450 - - - 550 500 450
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA 300 300 300 300 300 300 300 300 300
6 mA 500 450 450 500 450 450 500 450 450
8 mA 650 600 600 650 600 600 650 600 600
10 mA 700 650 600 700 650 600 700 650 600
12 mA 700 700 650 700 700 650 700 700 650
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
16 mA 500 500 450 - - - 500 500 450
18 mA 550 500 500 - - - 550 500 500
20 mA 650 550 550 - - - 550 550 550
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA 350 300 300 350 300 300 350 300 300
6 mA 500 500 450 500 500 450 500 500 450
8 mA 700 650 600 700 650 600 700 650 600
10 mA 700 700 650 - - - 700 700 650
12 mA 700 700 700 - - - 700 700 700
1.5-V HSTL
Class II
16 mA 600 600 550 - - - 600 600 550
18 mA 650 600 600 - - - 650 600 600
20 mA 700 650 600 - - - 700 650 600
Differential
SSTL-2 Class I (3)
8 mA 400 300 300 400 300 300 400 300 300
12 mA 400 400 350 400 400 350 400 400 350
Differential
SSTL-2 Class II
(3)
16 mA 350 350 300 350 350 300 350 350 300
20 mA 400 350 350 350 350 297 400 350 350
24 mA 400 400 350 - - - 400 400 350
Table 5–78. Maximum Output Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 2 of 5) Note (1)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Clock Outputs (MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
Altera Corporation 5–71
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Differential
SSTL-18 Class I
(3)
4 mA 200 150 150 200 150 150 200 150 150
6 mA 350 250 200 350 250 200 350 250 200
8 mA 450 300 300 450 300 300 450 300 300
10 mA 500 400 400 500 400 400 500 400 400
12 mA 700 550 400 350 350 297 650 550 400
Differential
SSTL-18 Class II
(3)
8 mA 200 200 150 - - - 200 200 150
16 mA 400 350 350 - - - 400 350 350
18 mA 450 400 400 - - - 450 400 400
20 mA 550 500 450 - - - 550 500 450
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class I (3)
4 mA 300 300 300 - - - 300 300 300
6 mA 500 450 450 - - - 500 450 450
8 mA 650 600 600 - - - 650 600 600
10 mA 700 650 600 - - - 700 650 600
12 mA 700 700 650 - - - 700 700 650
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class II (3)
16 mA 500 500 450 - - - 500 500 450
18 mA 550 500 500 - - - 550 500 500
20 mA 650 550 550 - - - 550 550 550
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class I (3)
4 mA 350 300 300 - - - 350 300 300
6 mA 500 500 450 - - - 500 500 450
8 mA 700 650 600 - - - 700 650 600
10 mA 700 700 650 - - - 700 700 650
12 mA 700 700 700 - - - 700 700 700
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class II (3)
16 mA 600 600 550 - - - 600 600 550
18 mA 650 600 600 - - - 650 600 600
20 mA 700 650 600 - - - 700 650 600
3.3-V PCI 1,000 790 670 - - - 1,000 790 670
3.3-V PCI-X 1,000 790 670 - - - 1,000 790 670
LVDS (6) - - - 500 500 500 450 400 300
HyperTransport
technology (4), (6)
500 500 500 - - -
LVPECL (5) - - - - - - 450 400 300
3.3-V LVTTL OCT 50 Ω400 400 350 400 400 350 400 400 350
2.5-V LVTTL OCT 50 Ω350 350 300 350 350 300 350 350 300
Table 5–78. Maximum Output Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 3 of 5) Note (1)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Clock Outputs (MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
5–72 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
1.8-V LVTTL OCT 50 Ω700 550 450 700 550 450 700 550 450
3.3-V LVCMOS OCT 50 Ω350 350 300 350 350 300 350 350 300
1.5-V LVCMOS OCT 50 Ω550 450 400 550 450 400 550 450 400
SSTL-2 Class I OCT 50 Ω600 500 500 600 500 500 600 500 500
SSTL-2 Class II OCT 25 Ω600 550 500 600 550 500 600 550 500
SSTL-18 Class I OCT 50 Ω560 400 350 590 400 350 450 400 350
SSTL-18 Class II OCT 25 Ω550 500 450 - - - 550 500 450
1.2-V HSTL (2) OCT 50 Ω280 - - - - - 280 - -
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
OCT 50 Ω600 550 500 600 550 500 600 550 500
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
OCT 50 Ω650 600 600 650 600 600 650 600 600
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
OCT 25 Ω500 500 450 - - - 500 500 450
Differential
SSTL-2 Class I
OCT 50 Ω600 500 500 600 500 500 600 500 500
Differential
SSTL-2 Class II
OCT 25 Ω600 550 500 600 550 500 600 550 500
Differential
SSTL-18 Class I
OCT 50 Ω560 400 350 590 400 350 560 400 350
Differential
SSTL-18 Class II
OCT 25 Ω550 500 450 - - - 550 500 450
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class I
OCT 50 Ω650 600 600 650 600 600 650 600 600
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class II
OCT 25 Ω500 500 450 - - - 500 500 450
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class I
OCT 50 Ω600 550 500 600 550 500 600 550 500
Table 5–78. Maximum Output Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 4 of 5) Note (1)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Clock Outputs (MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
Altera Corporation 5–73
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
1.2-V Differential
HSTL
OCT 50 Ω280 - - - - - 280 - -
Notes to Table 5–78:
(1) The toggle rate applies to 0-pF output load for all I/O standards except for LVDS and HyperTransport technology
on row I/O pins. For LVDS and HyperTransport technology on row I/O pins, the toggle rates apply to load from
0 to 5pF.
(2) 1.2-V HSTL is only supported on column I/O pins in I/O banks 4, 7, and 8.
(3) Differential HSTL and SSTL is only supported on column clock and DQS outputs.
(4) HyperTransport technology is only supported on row I/O and row dedicated clock input pins.
(5) LVPECL is only supported on column clock pins.
(6) Refer to Tables 5–81 through 5–91 if using SERDES block. Use the toggle rate values from the clock output column
for PLL output.
Table 5–79. Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (Part 1 of 5)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (ps/pF)
Column I/O Pins Row I/O Pins Dedicated Clock Outputs
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
3.3-V LVTTL 4 mA 478 510 510 478 510 510 466 510 510
8 mA 260 333 333 260 333 333 291 333 333
12 mA 213 247 247 213 247 247 211 247 247
16 mA 136 197 197 - - - 166 197 197
20 mA 138 187 187 - - - 154 187 187
24 mA 134 177 177 - - - 143 177 177
3.3-V LVCMOS 4 mA 377 391 391 377 391 391 377 391 391
8 mA 206 212 212 206 212 212 178 212 212
12 mA 141 145 145 - - - 115 145 145
16 mA 108 111 111 - - - 86 111 111
20 mA 83 88 88 - - - 79 88 88
24 mA 65 72 72 - - - 74 72 72
2.5-V
LVTTL/LVCMOS
4 mA 387 427 427 387 427 427 391 427 427
8 mA 163 224 224 163 224 224 170 224 224
12 mA 142 203 203 142 203 203 152 203 203
16 mA 120 182 182 - - - 134 182 182
Table 5–78. Maximum Output Toggle Rate on Stratix II Devices (Part 5 of 5) Note (1)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Column I/O Pins (MHz) Row I/O Pins (MHz) Clock Outputs (MHz)
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
5–74 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
1.8-V
LVTTL/LVCMOS
2 mA 951 1421 1421 951 1421 1421 904 1421 1421
4 mA 405 516 516 405 516 516 393 516 516
6 mA 261 325 325 261 325 325 253 325 325
8 mA 223 274 274 223 274 274 224 274 274
10 mA 194 236 236 - - - 199 236 236
12 mA 174 209 209 - - - 180 209 209
1.5-V
LVTTL/LVCMOS
2 mA 652 963 963 652 963 963 618 963 963
4 mA 333 347 347 333 347 347 270 347 347
6 mA 182 247 247 - - - 198 247 247
8 mA 135 194 194 - - - 155 194 194
SSTL-2 Class I 8 mA 364 680 680 364 680 680 350 680 680
12 mA 163 207 207 163 207 207 188 207 207
SSTL-2 Class II 16 mA 118 147 147 118 147 147 94 147 147
20 mA 99 122 122 - - - 87 122 122
24 mA 91 116 116 - - - 85 116 116
SSTL-18 Class I 4 mA 458 570 570 458 570 570 505 570 570
6 mA 305 380 380 305 380 380 336 380 380
8 mA 225 282 282 225 282 282 248 282 282
10 mA 167 220 220 167 220 220 190 220 220
12 mA 129 175 175 - - - 148 175 175
SSTL-18 Class II 8 mA 173 206 206 - - - 155 206 206
16 mA 150 160 160 - - - 140 160 160
18 mA 120 130 130 - - - 110 130 130
20 mA 109 127 127 - - - 94 127 127
SSTL-2 Class I 8 mA 364 680 680 364 680 680 350 680 680
12 mA 163 207 207 163 207 207 188 207 207
SSTL-2 Class II 16 mA 118 147 147 118 147 147 94 147 147
20 mA 99 122 122 - - - 87 122 122
24 mA 91 116 116 - - - 85 116 116
Table 5–79. Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (Part 2 of 5)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (ps/pF)
Column I/O Pins Row I/O Pins Dedicated Clock Outputs
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
Altera Corporation 5–75
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
SSTL-18 Class I 4 mA 458 570 570 458 570 570 505 570 570
6 mA 305 380 380 305 380 380 336 380 380
8 mA 225 282 282 225 282 282 248 282 282
10 mA 167 220 220 167 220 220 190 220 220
12 mA 129 175 175 - - - 148 175 175
SSTL-18 Class II 8 mA 173 206 206 - - - 155 206 206
16 mA 150 160 160 - - - 140 160 160
18 mA 120 130 130 - - - 110 130 130
20 mA 109 127 127 - - - 94 127 127
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA 245 282 282 245 282 282 229 282 282
6 mA 164 188 188 164 188 188 153 188 188
8 mA 123 140 140 123 140 140 114 140 140
10 mA 110 124 124 110 124 124 108 124 124
12 mA 97 110 110 97 110 110 104 110 110
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
16 mA 101 104 104 - - - 99 104 104
18 mA 98 102 102 - - - 93 102 102
20 mA 93 99 99 - - - 88 99 99
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
4 mA 168 196 196 168 196 196 188 196 196
6 mA 112 131 131 112 131 131 125 131 131
8 mA 84 99 99 84 99 99 95 99 99
10 mA 87 98 98 - - - 90 98 98
12 mA 86 98 98 - - - 87 98 98
1.5-V HSTL
Class II
16 mA 95 101 101 - - - 96 101 101
18 mA 95 100 100 - - - 101 100 100
20 mA 94 101 101 - - - 104 101 101
Differential
SSTL-2 Class II
(3)
8 mA 364 680 680 - - - 350 680 680
12 mA 163 207 207 - - - 188 207 207
16 mA 118 147 147 - - - 94 147 147
20 mA 99 122 122 - - - 87 122 122
24 mA 91 116 116 - - - 85 116 116
Table 5–79. Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (Part 3 of 5)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (ps/pF)
Column I/O Pins Row I/O Pins Dedicated Clock Outputs
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
5–76 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Timing Model
Differential
SSTL-18 Class I
(3)
4 mA 458 570 570 - - - 505 570 570
6 mA 305 380 380 - - - 336 380 380
8 mA 225 282 282 - - - 248 282 282
10 mA 167 220 220 - - - 190 220 220
12 mA 129 175 175 - - - 148 175 175
Differential
SSTL-18 Class II
(3)
8 mA 173 206 206 - - - 155 206 206
16 mA 150 160 160 - - - 140 160 160
18 mA 120 130 130 - - - 110 130 130
20 mA 109 127 127 - - - 94 127 127
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class I (3)
4 mA 245 282 282 - - - 229 282 282
6 mA 164 188 188 - - - 153 188 188
8 mA 123 140 140 - - - 114 140 140
10 mA 110 124 124 - - - 108 124 124
12 mA 97 110 110 - - - 104 110 110
1.8-V Differential
HSTL Class II (3)
16 mA 101 104 104 - - - 99 104 104
18 mA 98 102 102 - - - 93 102 102
20 mA 93 99 99 - - - 88 99 99
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class I (3)
4 mA 168 196 196 - - - 188 196 196
6 mA 112 131 131 - - - 125 131 131
8 mA 84 99 99 - - - 95 99 99
10 mA 87 98 98 - - - 90 98 98
12 mA 86 98 98 - - - 87 98 98
1.5-V Differential
HSTL Class II (3)
16 mA 95 101 101 - - - 96 101 101
18 mA 95 100 100 - - - 101 100 100
20 mA 94 101 101 - - - 104 101 101
3.3-V PCI 134 177 177 - - - 143 177 177
3.3-V PCI-X 134 177 177 - - - 143 177 177
LVDS - - - 155 (1) 155
(1)
155
(1)
134 134 134
HyperTransport
technology
- - - 155 (1) 155
(1)
155
(1)
-- -
LVPECL (4) - - - - - - 134 134 134
Table 5–79. Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (Part 4 of 5)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (ps/pF)
Column I/O Pins Row I/O Pins Dedicated Clock Outputs
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
Altera Corporation 5–77
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Duty Cycle
Distortion
Duty cycle distortion (DCD) describes how much the falling edge of a
clock is off from its ideal position. The ideal position is when both the
clock high time (CLKH) and the clock low time (CLKL) equal half of the
clock period (T), as shown in Figure 5–7. DCD is the deviation of the
non-ideal falling edge from the ideal falling edge, such as D1 for the
falling edge A and D2 for the falling edge B (Figure 5–7). The maximum
DCD for a clock is the larger value of D1 and D2.
3.3-V LVTTL OCT
50 Ω
133 152 152 133 152 152 147 152 152
2.5-V LVTTL OCT
50 Ω
207 274 274 207 274 274 235 274 274
1.8-V LVTTL OCT
50 Ω
151 165 165 151 165 165 153 165 165
3.3-V LVCMOS OCT
50 Ω
300 316 316 300 316 316 263 316 316
1.5-V LVCMOS OCT
50 Ω
157 171 171 157 171 171 174 171 171
SSTL-2 Class I OCT
50 Ω
121 134 134 121 134 134 77 134 134
SSTL-2 Class II OCT
25 Ω
56 101 101 56 101 101 58 101 101
SSTL-18 Class I OCT
50 Ω
100 123 123 100 123 123 106 123 123
SSTL-18 Class II OCT
25 Ω
61 110 110 - - - 59 110 110
1.2-V HSTL (2) OCT
50 Ω
95 - - - - - - - 95
Notes to Table 5–79:
(1) For LVDS and HyperTransport technology output on row I/O pins, the toggle rate derating factors apply to loads
larger than 5 pF. In the derating calculation, subtract 5 pF from the intended load value in pF for the correct result.
For a load less than or equal to 5 pF, refer to Table 578 for output toggle rates.
(2) 1.2-V HSTL is only supported on column I/O pins in I/O banks 4,7, and 8.
(3) Differential HSTL and SSTL is only supported on column clock and DQS outputs.
(4) LVPECL is only supported on column clock outputs.
Table 5–79. Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (Part 5 of 5)
I/O Standard Drive
Strength
Maximum Output Clock Toggle Rate Derating Factors (ps/pF)
Column I/O Pins Row I/O Pins Dedicated Clock Outputs
-3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5 -3 -4 -5
5–78 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Duty Cycle Distortion
Figure 5–7. Duty Cycle Distortion
DCD expressed in absolution derivation, for example, D1 or D2 in
Figure 5–7, is clock-period independent. DCD can also be expressed as a
percentage, and the percentage number is clock-period dependent. DCD
as a percentage is defined as
(T/2 – D1) / T (the low percentage boundary)
(T/2 + D2) / T (the high percentage boundary)
DCD Measurement Techniques
DCD is measured at an FPGA output pin driven by registers inside the
corresponding I/O element (IOE) block. When the output is a single data
rate signal (non-DDIO), only one edge of the register input clock (positive
or negative) triggers output transitions (Figure 5–8). Therefore, any DCD
present on the input clock signal or caused by the clock input buffer or
different input I/O standard does not transfer to the output signal.
Figure 5–8. DCD Measurement Technique for Non-DDIO (Single-Data Rate) Outputs
CLKH = T/2 CLKL = T/2
D1 D2
Falling Edge A
Ideal Falling Edge
Clock Period (T)
Falling Edge B
DQ
inst
PRN
CLRN
inst1
DFF
INPUT
VCC
clk
NOT
OUTPUT output
IOE
Altera Corporation 5–79
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
However, when the output is a double data rate input/output (DDIO)
signal, both edges of the input clock signal (positive and negative) trigger
output transitions (Figure 5–9). Therefore, any distortion on the input
clock and the input clock buffer affect the output DCD.
Figure 5–9. DCD Measurement Technique for DDIO (Double-Data Rate) Outputs
When an FPGA PLL generates the internal clock, the PLL output clocks
the IOE block. As the PLL only monitors the positive edge of the reference
clock input and internally re-creates the output clock signal, any DCD
present on the reference clock is filtered out. Therefore, the DCD for a
DDIO output with PLL in the clock path is better than the DCD for a
DDIO output without PLL in the clock path.
Tables 5–80 through 5–87 give the maximum DCD in absolution
derivation for different I/O standards on Stratix II devices. Examples are
also provided that show how to calculate DCD as a percentage.
DQ
inst2
PRN
CLRN
inst8
DFF
INPUT
VCC
clk
NOT
OUTPUT output
IOE
DQ
inst3
PRN
CLRN
DFF
V
CC
GND
Table 5–80. Maximum DCD for Non-DDIO Output on Row I/O Pins (Part 1
of 2) Note (1)
Row I/O Output
Standard
Maximum DCD for Non-DDIO Output
-3 Devices -4 & -5 Devices Unit
3.3-V LVTTTL 245 275 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 125 155 ps
2.5 V 105 135 ps
5–80 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Duty Cycle Distortion
Here is an example for calculating the DCD as a percentage for a
non-DDIO output on a row I/O on a -3 device:
If the non-DDIO output I/O standard is SSTL-2 Class II, the maximum
DCD is 95 ps (see Table 5–80). If the clock frequency is 267 MHz, the clock
period T is:
T = 1/ f = 1 / 267 MHz = 3.745 ns = 3745 ps
To calculate the DCD as a percentage:
(T/2 – DCD) / T = (3745ps/2 – 95ps) / 3745ps = 47.5% (for low
boundary)
(T/2 + DCD) / T = (3745ps/2 + 95ps) / 3745ps = 52.5% (for high
boundary)
1.8 V 180 180 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 165 195 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 115 145 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 95 125 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 55 85 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 80 100 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 85 115 ps
LVDS/
HyperTransport
technology
55 80 ps
Note to Table 5–80:
(1) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
Table 5–80. Maximum DCD for Non-DDIO Output on Row I/O Pins (Part 2
of 2) Note (1)
Row I/O Output
Standard
Maximum DCD for Non-DDIO Output
-3 Devices -4 & -5 Devices Unit
Altera Corporation 5–81
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Therefore, the DCD percentage for the 267 MHz SSTL-2 Class II
non-DDIO row output clock on a –3 device ranges from 47.5% to 52.5%.
Table 5–81. Maximum DCD for Non-DDIO Output on Column I/O
Pins Note (1)
Column I/O Output
Standard I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD for Non-DDIO Output
Unit
-3 Devices -4 & -5 Devices
3.3-V LVTTL 190 220 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 140 175 ps
2.5 V 125 155 ps
1.8 V 80 110 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 185 215 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 105 135 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 100 130 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 90 115 ps
SSTL-18 Class II 70 100 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class I
80 110 ps
1.8-V HSTL
Class II
80 110 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class I
85 115 ps
1.5-V HSTL
Class II
50 80 ps
1.2-V HSTL (2) 170 - ps
LVPECL 55 80 ps
Notes to Tab l e 5 8 1 :
(1) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
(2) 1.2-V HSTL is only supported in -3 devices.
5–82 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Duty Cycle Distortion
Here is an example for calculating the DCD in percentage for a DDIO
output on a row I/O on a -3 device:
If the input I/O standard is SSTL-2 and the DDIO output I/O standard is
SSTL-2 Class II, the maximum DCD is 60 ps (see Table 5–82). If the clock
frequency is 267 MHz, the clock period T is:
T = 1/ f = 1 / 267 MHz = 3.745 ns = 3745 ps
Calculate the DCD as a percentage:
(T/2 – DCD) / T = (3745ps/2 – 60ps) / 3745ps = 48.4% (for low
boundary)
(T/2 + DCD) / T = (3745 ps/2 + 60 ps) / 3745ps = 51.6% (for high
boundary)
Table 5–82. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Row I/O Pins Without PLL in the Clock Path for -3
Devices Notes (1), (2)
Row DDIO Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD Based on I/O Standard of Input Feeding the DDIO Clock Port
(No PLL in Clock Path)
Unit
TTL/CMOS SSTL-2 SSTL/HSTL
LVDS/
HyperTransport
Technology
3.3 & 2.5 V 1.8 & 1.5 V 2.5 V 1.8 & 1.5 V 3.3 V
3.3-V LVTTL 260 380 145 145 110 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 210 330 100 100 65 ps
2.5 V 195 315 85 85 75 ps
1.8 V 150 265 85 85 120 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 255 370 140 140 105 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 175 295 65 65 70 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 170 290 60 60 75 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 155 275 55 50 90 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 150 270 60 60 95 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 150 270 55 55 90 ps
LVDS/ HyperTransport
technology
180 180 180 180 180 ps
Notes to Table 5–82:
(1) The information in Table 582 assumes the input clock has zero DCD.
(2) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
Altera Corporation 5–83
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Therefore, the DCD percentage for the 267 MHz SSTL-2 Class II DDIO
row output clock on a –3 device ranges from 48.4% to 51.6%.
Table 5–83. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Row I/O Pins Without PLL in the Clock Path for -4 & -5
Devices Notes (1), (2)
Row DDIO Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD Based on I/O Standard of Input Feeding the DDIO Clock
Port (No PLL in the Clock Path)
Unit
TTL/CMOS SSTL-2 SSTL/HSTL
LVDS/
HyperTransport
Technology
3.3/2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 3.3 V
3.3-V LVTTL 440 495 170 160 105 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 390 450 120 110 75 ps
2.5 V 375 430 105 95 90 ps
1.8 V 325 385 90 100 135 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 430 490 160 155 100 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 355 410 85 75 85 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 350 405 80 70 90 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 335 390 65 65 105 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 330 385 60 70 110 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 330 390 60 70 105 ps
LVDS/ HyperTransport
technology
180 180 180 180 180 ps
Notes to Table 5–83:
(1) Table 583 assumes the input clock has zero DCD.
(2) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
Table 5–84. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Column I/O Pins Without PLL in the Clock Path for -3
Devices (Part 1 of 2) Notes (1), (2)
DDIO Column Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD Based on I/O Standard of Input Feeding the DDIO
Clock Port (No PLL in the Clock Path)
Unit
TTL/CMOS SSTL-2 SSTL/HSTL 1.2-V
HSTL
3.3/2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 1.2 V
3.3-V LVTTL 260 380 145 145 145 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 210 330 100 100 100 ps
2.5 V 195 315 85 85 85 ps
5–84 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Duty Cycle Distortion
1.8 V 150 265 85 85 85 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 255 370 140 140 140 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 175 295 65 65 65 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 170 290 60 60 60 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 155 275 55 50 50 ps
SSTL-18 Class II 140 260 70 70 70 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 150 270 60 60 60 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class II 150 270 60 60 60 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 150 270 55 55 55 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class II 125 240 85 85 85 ps
1.2-V HSTL 240 360 155 155 155 ps
LVPECL 180 180 180 180 180 ps
Notes to Table 5–84:
(1) Table 584 assumes the input clock has zero DCD.
(2) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
Table 5–85. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Column I/O Pins Without PLL in the Clock Path for -4 & -5
Devices (Part 1 of 2) Notes (1), (2)
DDIO Column Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD Based on I/O Standard of Input Feeding the DDIO
Clock Port (No PLL in the Clock Path)
Unit
TTL/CMOS SSTL-2 SSTL/HSTL
3.3/2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V
3.3-V LVTTL 440 495 170 160 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 390 450 120 110 ps
2.5 V 375 430 105 95 ps
1.8 V 325 385 90 100 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 430 490 160 155 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 355 410 85 75 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 350 405 80 70 ps
Table 5–84. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Column I/O Pins Without PLL in the Clock Path for -3
Devices (Part 2 of 2) Notes (1), (2)
DDIO Column Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD Based on I/O Standard of Input Feeding the DDIO
Clock Port (No PLL in the Clock Path)
Unit
TTL/CMOS SSTL-2 SSTL/HSTL 1.2-V
HSTL
3.3/2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 1.2 V
Altera Corporation 5–85
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
SSTL-18 Class I 335 390 65 65 ps
SSTL-18 Class II 320 375 70 80 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 330 385 60 70 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class II 330 385 60 70 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 330 390 60 70 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class II 330 360 90 100 ps
1.2-V HSTL 420 470 155 165 ps
LVPECL 180 180 180 180 ps
Notes to Table 5–85:
(1) Table 585 assumes the input clock has zero DCD.
(2) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
Table 5–85. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Column I/O Pins Without PLL in the Clock Path for -4 & -5
Devices (Part 2 of 2) Notes (1), (2)
DDIO Column Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD Based on I/O Standard of Input Feeding the DDIO
Clock Port (No PLL in the Clock Path)
Unit
TTL/CMOS SSTL-2 SSTL/HSTL
3.3/2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V 2.5 V 1.8/1.5 V
Table 5–86. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Row I/O Pins with PLL in the
Clock Path (Part 1 of 2) Note (1)
Row DDIO Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD (PLL Output Clock Feeding
DDIO Clock Port) Unit
-3 Device -4 & -5 Device
3.3-V LVTTL 110 105 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 65 75 ps
2.5V 75 90 ps
1.8V 85 100 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 105 100 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 65 75 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 60 70 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 50 65 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 50 70 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 55 70 ps
5–86 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Duty Cycle Distortion
LVDS/ HyperTransport
technology
180 180 ps
Note to Table 5–86:
(1) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
Table 5–87. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Column I/O with PLL in the
Clock Path Note (1)
Column DDIO Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD (PLL Output Clock Feeding
DDIO Clock Port) Unit
-3 Device -4 & -5 Device
3.3-V LVTTL 145 160 ps
3.3-V LVCMOS 100 110 ps
2.5V 85 95 ps
1.8V 85 100 ps
1.5-V LVCMOS 140 155 ps
SSTL-2 Class I 65 75 ps
SSTL-2 Class II 60 70 ps
SSTL-18 Class I 50 65 ps
SSTL-18 Class II 70 80 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class I 60 70 ps
1.8-V HSTL Class II 60 70 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class I 55 70 ps
1.5-V HSTL Class II 85 100 ps
1.2-V HSTL 155 - ps
LVPECL 180 180 ps
Notes to Tab l e 5 8 7 :
(1) The DCD specification is based on a no logic array noise condition.
(2) 1.2-V HSTL is only supported in -3 devices.
Table 5–86. Maximum DCD for DDIO Output on Row I/O Pins with PLL in the
Clock Path (Part 2 of 2) Note (1)
Row DDIO Output I/O
Standard
Maximum DCD (PLL Output Clock Feeding
DDIO Clock Port) Unit
-3 Device -4 & -5 Device
Altera Corporation 5–87
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
High-Speed I/O
Specifications
Table 5–88 provides high-speed timing specifications definitions.
Table 5–89 shows the high-speed I/O timing specifications for -3 speed
grade Stratix II devices.
Table 5–88. High-Speed Timing Specifications & Definitions
High-Speed Timing Specifications Definitions
tCHigh-speed receiver/transmitter input and output clock period.
fHSCLK High-speed receiver/transmitter input and output clock frequency.
J Deserialization factor (width of parallel data bus).
W PLL multiplication factor.
tRISE Low-to-high transmission time.
tFALL High-to-low transmission time.
Timing unit interval (TUI) The timing budget allowed for skew, propagation delays, and data
sampling window. (TUI = 1/(Receiver Input Clock Frequency ×
Multiplication Factor) = tC/w).
fHSDR Maximum/minimum LVDS data transfer rate (fHSDR = 1/TUI), non-DPA.
fHSDRDPA Maximum/minimum LVDS data transfer rate (fHSDRDPA = 1/TUI), DPA.
Channel-to-channel skew (TCCS) The timing difference between the fastest and slowest output edges,
including tCO variation and clock skew. The clock is included in the TCCS
measurement.
Sampling window (SW) The period of time during which the data must be valid in order to capture
it correctly. The setup and hold times determine the ideal strobe position
within the sampling window.
Input jitter Peak-to-peak input jitter on high-speed PLLs.
Output jitter Peak-to-peak output jitter on high-speed PLLs.
tDUTY Duty cycle on high-speed transmitter output clock.
tLOCK Lock time for high-speed transmitter and receiver PLLs.
Table 5–89. High-Speed I/O Specifications for -3 Speed Grade (Part 1 of 2) Notes (1), (2)
Symbol Conditions -3 Speed Grade Unit
Min Typ Max
fHSCLK (clock frequency)
fHSCLK = fHSDR / W
W = 2 to 32 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology)
(3)
16 520 MHz
W = 1 (SERDES bypass, LVDS only) 16 500 MHz
W = 1 (SERDES used, LVDS only) 150 717 MHz
5–88 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
High-Speed I/O Specifications
fHSDR (data rate) J = 4 to 10 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) 150 1,040 Mbps
J = 2 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) (4) 760 Mbps
J = 1 (LVDS only) (4) 500 Mbps
fHSDRDPA (DPA data rate) J = 4 to 10 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) 150 1,040 Mbps
TCCS All differential standards - 200 ps
SW All differential standards 330 - ps
Output jitter 190 ps
Output tRISE All differential I/O standards 160 ps
Output tFAL L All differential I/O standards 180 ps
tDUTY 45 50 55 %
DPA run length 6,400 UI
DPA jitter tolerance Data channel peak-to-peak jitter 0.44 UI
DPA lock time Standard Training
Pattern
Transition
Density
Number of
repetitions
SPI-4 0000000000
1111111111
10% 256
Parallel Rapid I/O 00001111 25% 256
10010000 50% 256
Miscellaneous 10101010 100% 256
01010101 256
Notes to Table 5–89:
(1) When J = 4 to 10, the SERDES block is used.
(2) When J = 1 or 2, the SERDES block is bypassed.
(3) The input clock frequency and the W factor must satisfy the following fast PLL VCO specification: 150 input clock
frequency × W 1,040.
(4) The minimum specification is dependent on the clock source (fast PLL, enhanced PLL, clock pin, and so on) and
the clock routing resource (global, regional, or local) utilized. The I/O differential buffer and input register do not
have a minimum toggle rate.
Table 5–89. High-Speed I/O Specifications for -3 Speed Grade (Part 2 of 2) Notes (1), (2)
Symbol Conditions -3 Speed Grade Unit
Min Typ Max
Altera Corporation 5–89
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–90 shows the high-speed I/O timing specifications for -4 speed
grade Stratix II devices.
Table 5–90. High-Speed I/O Specifications for -4 Speed Grade Notes (1), (2)
Symbol Conditions -4 Speed Grade Unit
Min Typ Max
fHSCLK (clock frequency)
fHSCLK = fHSDR / W
W = 2 to 32 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology)
(3)
16 520 MHz
W = 1 (SERDES bypass, LVDS only) 16 500 MHz
W = 1 (SERDES used, LVDS only) 150 717 MHz
fHSDR (data rate) J = 4 to 10 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) 150 1,040 Mbps
J = 2 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) (4) 760 Mbps
J = 1 (LVDS only) (4) 500 Mbps
fHSDRDPA (DPA data rate) J = 4 to 10 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) 150 1,040 Mbps
TCCS All differential standards - 200 ps
SW All differential standards 330 - ps
Output jitter 190 ps
Output tRISE All differential I/O standards 160 ps
Output tFAL L All differential I/O standards 180 ps
tDUTY 45 50 55 %
DPA run length 6,400 UI
DPA jitter tolerance Data channel peak-to-peak jitter 0.44 UI
DPA lock time Standard Training
Pattern
Transition
Density
Number of
repetitions
SPI-4 0000000000
1111111111
10% 256
Parallel Rapid I/O 00001111 25% 256
10010000 50% 256
Miscellaneous 10101010 100% 256
01010101 256
Notes to Table 5–90:
(1) When J = 4 to 10, the SERDES block is used.
(2) When J = 1 or 2, the SERDES block is bypassed.
(3) The input clock frequency and the W factor must satisfy the following fast PLL VCO specification: 150 input clock
frequency × W 1,040.
(4) The minimum specification is dependent on the clock source (fast PLL, enhanced PLL, clock pin, and so on) and
the clock routing resource (global, regional, or local) utilized. The I/O differential buffer and input register do not
have a minimum toggle rate.
5–90 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
High-Speed I/O Specifications
Table 5–91 shows the high-speed I/O timing specifications for -5 speed
grade Stratix II devices.
Table 5–91. High-Speed I/O Specifications for -5 Speed Grade Notes (1), (2)
Symbol Conditions -5 Speed Grade Unit
Min Typ Max
fHSCLK (clock frequency)
fHSCLK = fHSDR / W
W = 2 to 32 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology)
(3)
16 420 MHz
W = 1 (SERDES bypass, LVDS only) 16 500 MHz
W = 1 (SERDES used, LVDS only) 150 640 MHz
fHSDR (data rate) J = 4 to 10 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) 150 840 Mbps
J = 2 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) (4) 700 Mbps
J = 1 (LVDS only) (4) 500 Mbps
fHSDRDPA (DPA data rate) J = 4 to 10 (LVDS, HyperTransport technology) 150 840 Mbps
TCCS All differential I/O standards - 200 ps
SW All differential I/O standards 440 - ps
Output jitter 190 ps
Output tRISE All differential I/O standards 290 ps
Output tFAL L All differential I/O standards 290 ps
tDUTY 45 50 55 %
DPA run length 6,400 UI
DPA jitter tolerance Data channel peak-to-peak jitter 0.44 UI
DPA lock time Standard Training
Pattern
Transition
Density
Number of
repetitions
SPI-4 0000000000
1111111111
10% 256
Parallel Rapid I/O 00001111 25% 256
10010000 50% 256
Miscellaneous 10101010 100% 256
01010101 256
Notes to Table 5–91:
(1) When J = 4 to 10, the SERDES block is used.
(2) When J = 1 or 2, the SERDES block is bypassed.
(3) The input clock frequency and the W factor must satisfy the following fast PLL VCO specification: 150 input clock
frequency × W 1,040.
(4) The minimum specification is dependent on the clock source (fast PLL, enhanced PLL, clock pin, and so on) and
the clock routing resource (global, regional, or local) utilized. The I/O differential buffer and input register do not
have a minimum toggle rate.
Altera Corporation 5–91
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
PLL Timing
Specifications
Tables 5–92 and 5–93 describe the Stratix II PLL specifications when
operating in both the commercial junction temperature range (0 to 85 °C)
and the industrial junction temperature range (–40 to 100 °C).
Table 5–92. Enhanced PLL Specifications (Part 1 of 2)
Name Description Min Typ Max Unit
fIN Input clock frequency 2 500 MHz
fINPFD Input frequency to the
PFD
2 420 MHz
fINDUTY Input clock duty cycle 40 60 %
fEINDUTY External feedback
input clock duty cycle
40 60 %
tINJITTER Input or external
feedback clock input
jitter tolerance in
terms of period jitter.
Bandwidth
0.85 MHz
0.5 ns (p-p)
Input or external
feedback clock input
jitter tolerance in
terms of period jitter.
Bandwidth >
0.85 MHz
1.0 ns (p-p)
tOUTJITTER Dedicated clock
output period jitter
250 ps for 100 MHz outclk
25 mUI for < 100 MHz outclk
ps or mUI
(p-p)
tFCOMP External feedback
compensation time
10 ns
fOUT Output frequency for
internal global or
regional clock
1.5
(2)
550.0 MHz
tOUTDUTY Duty cycle for external
clock output (when set
to 50%).
45 50 55 %
fSCANCLK Scanclk frequency 100 MHz
tCONFIGPLL Time required to
reconfigure scan
chains for enhanced
PLLs
174/fSCANCLK ns
fOUT_EXT PLL external clock
output frequency
1.5
(2)
550.0 (1) MHz
5–92 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
PLL Timing Specifications
tLOCK Time required for the
PLL to lock from the
time it is enabled or
the end of device
configuration
0.03 1 ms
tDLOCK Time required for the
PLL to lock
dynamically after
automatic clock
switchover between
two identical clock
frequencies
1ms
fSWITCHOVER Frequency range
where the clock
switchover performs
properly
4 500 MHz
fCLBW PLL closed-loop
bandwidth
0.13 1.20 16.90 MHz
fVCO PLL VCO operating
range for –3 and –4
speed grade devices
300 1,040 MHz
PLL VCO operating
range for –5 speed
grade devices
300 840 MHz
fSS Spread-spectrum
modulation frequency
30 150 kHz
% spread Percent down spread
for a given clock
frequency
0.4 0.5 0.6 %
tPLL_PSERR Accuracy of PLL
phase shift
±15 ps
tARESET Minimum pulse width
on areset signal.
10 ns
tARESET_RECONFIG Minimum pulse width
on the areset signal
when using PLL
reconfiguration. Reset
the PLL after
scandone goes
high.
500 ns
Notes to Table 5–92:
(1) Limited by I/O fMAX. See Table 5–78 on page 5–69 for the maximum. Cannot exceed fOUT specification.
(2) If the counter cascading feature of the PLL is utilized, there is no minimum output clock frequency.
Table 5–92. Enhanced PLL Specifications (Part 2 of 2)
Name Description Min Typ Max Unit
Altera Corporation 5–93
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–93. Fast PLL Specifications
Name Description Min Typ Max Unit
fIN Input clock frequency (for -3 and -4 speed
grade devices)
16.08 717 MHz
Input clock frequency (for -5 speed grade
devices)
16.08 640 MHz
fINPFD Input frequency to the PFD 16.08 500 MHz
fINDUTY Input clock duty cycle 40 60 %
tINJITTER Input clock jitter tolerance in terms of period
jitter. Bandwidth 2MHz
0.5 ns (p-p)
Input clock jitter tolerance in terms of period
jitter. Bandwidth > 2MHz
1.0 ns (p-p)
fVCO Upper VCO frequency range for –3 and –4
speed grades
300 1,040 MHz
Upper VCO frequency range for –5 speed
grades
300 840 MHz
Lower VCO frequency range for –3 and –4
speed grades
150 520 MHz
Lower VCO frequency range for –5 speed
grades
150 420 MHz
fOUT PLL output frequency to GCLK or RCLK 4.6875 550 MHz
PLL output frequency to LVDS or DPA clock 150 1,040 MHz
fOUT_IO PLL clock output frequency to regular I/O
pin
4.6875 (1) MHz
fSCANCLK Scanclk frequency 100 MHz
tCONFIGPLL Time required to reconfigure scan chains
for fast PLLs
75/fSCANCLK ns
fCLBW PLL closed-loop bandwidth 1.16 5.00 28.00 MHz
tLOCK Time required for the PLL to lock from the
time it is enabled or the end of the device
configuration
0.03 1.00 ms
tPLL_PSERR Accuracy of PLL phase shift ±15 ps
tARESET Minimum pulse width on areset signal. 10 ns
tARESET_RECONFIG Minimum pulse width on the areset signal
when using PLL reconfiguration. Reset the
PLL after scandone goes high.
500 ns
Note to Table 5–93:
(1) Limited by I/O fMAX. See Table 5–77 on page 5–67 for the maximum.
5–94 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
External Memory Interface Specifications
External
Memory
Interface
Specifications
Tables 5–94 through 5–101 contain Stratix II device specifications for the
dedicated circuitry used for interfacing with external memory devices.
Table 5–95 lists the maximum delay in the fast timing model for the
Stratix II DQS delay buffer. Multiply the number of delay buffers that you
are using in the DQS logic block to get the maximum delay achievable in
your system. For example, if you implement a 90° phase shift at 200 MHz,
you use three delay buffers in mode 2. The maximum achievable delay
from the DQS block is then 3 × .416 ps = 1.248 ns.
Table 5–94. DLL Frequency Range Specifications
Frequency Mode Frequency Range Resolution
(Degrees)
0 100 to 175 30
1 150 to 230 22.5
2 200 to 310 30
3 240 to 400 (–3 speed grade) 36
240 to 350 (–4 and –5 speed grades) 36
Table 5–95. DQS Delay Buffer Maximum Delay in Fast Timing Model
Frequency Mode Maximum Delay Per Delay Buffer
(Fast Timing Model) Unit
0 0.833 ns
1, 2, 3 0.416 ns
Table 5–96. DQS Period Jitter Specifications for DLL-Delayed Clock
(tDQS_JITTER) Note (1)
Number of DQS Delay Buffer
Stages (2) Commercial Industrial Unit
1 80 110 ps
2 110 130 ps
3 130 180 ps
4 160 210 ps
Notes to Tab l e 5 9 6 :
(1) Peak-to-peak period jitter on the phase shifted DQS clock.
(2) Delay stages used for requested DQS phase shift are reported in your project’s
Compilation Report in the Quartus II software.
Altera Corporation 5–95
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–97. DQS Phase Jitter Specifications for DLL-Delayed Clock
(tDQS PHASE_JITTER) Note (1)
Number of DQS Delay
Buffer Stages (2) DQS Phase Jitter Unit
130ps
260ps
390ps
4 120 ps
Notes to Tab l e 5 9 7 :
(1) Peak-to-peak phase jitter on the phase shifted DDS clock (digital jitter is caused
by DLL tracking).
(2) Delay stages used for requested DQS phase shift are reported in your project’s
Compilation Report in the Quartus II software.
Table 5–98. DQS Phase-Shift Error Specifications for DLL-Delayed Clock (tDQS_PSERR) (1)
Number of DQS Delay Buffer Stages (2) –3 Speed Grade –4 Speed Grade –5 Speed Grade Unit
1 253035ps
2 506070ps
3 75 90 105 ps
4 100 120 140 ps
Notes to Table 5–98:
(1) This error specification is the absolute maximum and minimum error. For example, skew on three delay buffer
stages in a C3 speed grade is 75 ps or ± 37.5 ps.
(2) Delay stages used for requested DQS phase shift are reported in your project’s Compilation Report in the
Quartus II software.
Table 5–99. DQS Bus Clock Skew Adder Specifications
(tDQS_CLOCK_SKEW_ADDER)
Mode DQS Clock Skew Adder Unit
×4 DQ per DQS 40 ps
×9 DQ per DQS 70 ps
×18 DQ per DQS 75 ps
×36 DQ per DQS 95 ps
Note to Table 5–99:
(1) This skew specification is the absolute maximum and minimum skew. For
example, skew on a ×4 DQ group is 40 ps or ±20 ps.
5–96 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
JTAG Timing Specifications
JTAG Timing
Specifications
Figure 5–10 shows the timing requirements for the JTAG signals.
Figure 5–10. Stratix II JTAG Waveforms
Table 5–100. DQS Phase Offset Delay Per Stage Notes (1), (2), (3)
Speed Grade Min Max Unit
-3 9 14 ps
-4 9 14 ps
-5 9 15 ps
Notes to Table 5–100:
(1) The delay settings are linear.
(2) The valid settings for phase offset are -64 to +63 for frequency mode 0 and -32 to
+31 for frequency modes 1, 2, and 3.
(3) The typical value equals the average of the minimum and maximum values.
Table 5–101. DDIO Outputs Half-Period Jitter Notes (1), (2)
Name Description Max Unit
tOUTHALFJITTER Half-period jitter (PLL driving DDIO outputs) 200 ps
Notes to Table 5–101:
(1) The worst-case half period is equal to the ideal half period subtracted by the DCD
and half-period jitter values.
(2) The half-period jitter was characterized using a PLL driving DDIO outputs.
TDO
TCK
tJPZX tJPCO
tJPH
tJPXZ
tJCP
tJPSU
t JCL
tJCH
TDI
TMS
Altera Corporation 5–97
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
Table 5–102 shows the JTAG timing parameters and values for Stratix II
devices.
Document
Revision History
Table 5–103 shows the revision history for this chapter.
Table 5–102. Stratix II JTAG Timing Parameters & Values
Symbol Parameter Min Max Unit
tJCP TCK clock period 30 ns
tJCH TCK clock high time 13 ns
tJCL TCK clock low time 13 ns
tJPSU JTAG port setup time 3 ns
tJPH JTAG port hold time 5 ns
tJPCO JTAG port clock to output 11 (1) ns
tJPZX JTAG port high impedance to valid output 14 (1) ns
tJPXZ JTAG port valid output to high impedance 14 (1) ns
Note to Table 5–102:
(1) A 1 ns adder is required for each VCCIO voltage step down from 3.3 V. For
example, tJPCO = 12 ns if VCCIO of the TDO I/O bank = 2.5 V, or 13 ns if it equals
1.8 V.
Table 5–103. Document Revision History (Part 1 of 3)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
April 2011, v4.5 Updated Ta b l e 5 3 . Added operating junction temperature
for military use.
July 2009, v4.4 Updated Ta b l e 5 9 2 . Updated the spread spectrum
modulation frequency (fSS) from
(100 kHz–500 kHz) to
(30 kHz–150 kHz).
May 2007, v4.3 Updated RCONF in Table 5–4.
Updated fIN (min) in Table 5–92.
Updated fIN and fINPFD in Table 5–93.
Moved the Document Revision History section to the
end of the chapter.
5–98 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Document Revision History
August, 2006,
v4.2
Updated Table 5–73, Table 5–75, Table 5–77,
Table 5–78, Table 5–79, Table 5–81, Table 5–85, and
Table 5–87.
April 2006, v4.1 Updated Table 5–3.
Updated Table 5–11.
Updated Figures 5–8 and 5–9.
Added parallel on-chip termination information to
“On-Chip Termination Specifications” section.
Updated Tables 5–28, 5–30,5–31, and 5–34.
Updated Table 5–78, Tables 5–81 through 5–90,
and Tables 5–92, 5–93, and 5–98.
Updated “PLL Timing Specifications” section.
Updated “External Memory Interface
Specifications” section.
Added Tables 5–95 and 5–101.
Updated “JTAG Timing Specifications” section,
including Figure 5–10 and Table 5–102.
Changed 0.2 MHz to 2 MHz in
Table 5–93.
Added new spec for half period
jitter (Table 5–101).
Added support for PLL clock
switchover for industrial
temperature range.
Changed fINPFD (min) spec from
4 MHz to 2 MHz in Table 5–92.
Fixed typo in tOUTJITTER
specification in Table 5–92.
Updated VDIF AC & DC max
specifications in Table 5–28.
Updated minimum values for tJCH,
tJCL, and tJPSU in Table 5–102.
Update maximum values for tJPCO,
tJPZX, and tJPXZ in Table 5–102.
December 2005,
v4.0
Updated “External Memory Interface
Specifications” section.
Updated timing numbers throughout chapter.
July 2005, v3.1 Updated HyperTransport technology information in
Table 5–13.
Updated “Timing Model” section.
Updated “PLL Timing Specifications” section.
Updated “External Memory Interface
Specifications” section.
May 2005, v3.0 Updated tables throughout chapter.
Updated “Power Consumption” section.
Added various tables.
Replaced “Maximum Input & Output Clock Rate”
section with “Maximum Input & Output Clock Toggle
Rate” section.
Added “Duty Cycle Distortion” section.
Added “External Memory Interface Specifications”
section.
March 2005,
v2.2
Updated tables in “Internal Timing Parameters”
section.
January 2005,
v2.1
Updated input rise and fall time.
Table 5–103. Document Revision History (Part 2 of 3)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
Altera Corporation 5–99
April 2011 Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1
DC & Switching Characteristics
January 2005,
v2.0
Updated the “Power Consumption” section.
Added the “High-Speed I/O Specifications” and
“On-Chip Termination Specifications” sections.
Removed the ESD Protection Specifications
section.
Updated Tables 5–3 through 5–13, 5–16 through
5–18, 5–21, 5–35, 5–39, and 5–40.
Updated tables in “Timing Model” section.
Added Tables 5–30 and 5–31.
October 2004,
v1.2
Updated Table 5–3.
Updated introduction text in the “PLL Timing
Specifications” section.
July 2004, v1.1 Re-organized chapter.
Added typical values and COUTFB to Table 5–32.
Added undershoot specification to Note (4) for
Tables 5–1 through 5–9.
Added Note (1) to Tables 5–5 and 5–6.
Added VID and VICM to Table 5–10.
Added “I/O Timing Measurement Methodology”
section.
Added Table 5–72.
Updated Tables 5–1 through 5–2 and Tables 5–24
through 5–29.
February 2004,
v1.0
Added document to the Stratix II Device Handbook.
Table 5–103. Document Revision History (Part 3 of 3)
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
5–100 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Document Revision History
Altera Corporation 6–1
April 2011
6. Reference & Ordering
Information
Software Stratix®II devices are supported by the Altera® Quartus®II design
software, which provides a comprehensive environment for system-on-a-
programmable-chip (SOPC) design. The Quartus II software includes
HDL and schematic design entry, compilation and logic synthesis, full
simulation and advanced timing analysis, SignalTap®II logic analyzer,
and device configuration. See the Quartus II Handbook for more
information on the Quartus II software features.
The Quartus II software supports the Windows XP/2000/NT/98, Sun
Solaris, Linux Red Hat v7.1 and HP-UX operating systems. It also
supports seamless integration with industry-leading EDA tools through
the NativeLink® interface.
Device Pin-Outs Device pin-outs for Stratix II devices are available on the Altera web site
at (www.altera.com).
Ordering
Information
Figure 6–1 describes the ordering codes for Stratix II devices. For more
information on a specific package, refer to the Package Information for
Stratix II & Stratix II GX Devices chapter in volume 2 of the Stratix II Device
Handbook or the Stratix II GX Device Handbook.
SII51006-2.2
6–2 Altera Corporation
Stratix II Device Handbook, Volume 1 April 2011
Document Revision History
Figure 6–1. Stratix II Device Packaging Ordering Information
Note to Figure 6–1:
(1) Applicable to I4 devices. For more information, refer to the Stratix II Military Temperature Range Support technical
brief.
Document
Revision History
Table 6–1 shows the revision history for this chapter.
Device Type
Package Type
3, 4, or 5, with 3 being the fastest
Number of pins for a particular FineLine BGA package
ES:
F: FineLine BGA
H: Hybrid FineLine BGA
EP2S: Stratix II
15
30
60
90
130
180
Optional SuffixFamily Signature
Operating Temperature
Speed Grade
Pin Count
Engineering sample
7EP2S 90 C1508FES
Indicates specific device options or
shipment method.
C:
I:
Commercial temperature (t
J
= 0
°
C to 85
°
C)
Industrial temperature (t
J
= -40
°
C to 100
°
C)
Military temperature (t
J
= -55
°
C to 125
°
C) (1
)
Table 6–1. Document Revision History
Date and
Document
Version
Changes Made Summary of Changes
April 2011,
v2.2
Updated Figure 6–1. Added operating junction temperature
for military use.
May 2007,
v2.1
Moved the Document Revision History section to the end
of the chapter.
January
2005, v2.0
Contact information was removed.
October
2004, v1.1
Updated Figure 6–1.
February
2004, v1.0
Added document to the Stratix II Device Handbook.